blob: f397f411c6d872a06a22cde8bc7b35f7f72935a0 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
2 HAProxy
3 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau21475e32010-05-23 08:46:08 +02005 version 1.5
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreau04df1122011-04-08 00:56:41 +02007 2011/04/08
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
11specified above. It does not provide any hint, example or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013The summary below is meant to help you search sections by name and navigate
14through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
17 This document is formated with 80 columns per line, with even number of
18 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
22 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to help get the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when it can become ambiguous. If you add sections,
25 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
341.2.1. The Request line
351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
371.3.1. The Response line
381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
422.2. Time format
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200432.3. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020044
453. Global parameters
463.1. Process management and security
473.2. Performance tuning
483.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100493.4. Userlists
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020050
514. Proxies
524.1. Proxy keywords matrix
534.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
54
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +0100555. Server and default-server options
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020056
576. HTTP header manipulation
58
Cyril Bonté7d38afb2010-02-03 20:41:26 +0100597. Using ACLs and pattern extraction
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200607.1. Matching integers
617.2. Matching strings
627.3. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
637.4. Matching IPv4 addresses
647.5. Available matching criteria
657.5.1. Matching at Layer 4 and below
667.5.2. Matching contents at Layer 4
677.5.3. Matching at Layer 7
687.6. Pre-defined ACLs
697.7. Using ACLs to form conditions
Cyril Bonté7d38afb2010-02-03 20:41:26 +0100707.8. Pattern extraction
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020071
728. Logging
738.1. Log levels
748.2. Log formats
758.2.1. Default log format
768.2.2. TCP log format
778.2.3. HTTP log format
788.3. Advanced logging options
798.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
808.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
818.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
828.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
838.4. Timing events
848.5. Session state at disconnection
858.6. Non-printable characters
868.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
878.8. Capturing HTTP headers
888.9. Examples of logs
89
909. Statistics and monitoring
919.1. CSV format
929.2. Unix Socket commands
93
94
951. Quick reminder about HTTP
96----------------------------
97
98When haproxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
99fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
100on almost anything found in the contents.
101
102However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
103formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
104correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
105
106
1071.1. The HTTP transaction model
108-------------------------------
109
110The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100111to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200112from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client on the
113connection, the server responds and the connection is closed. A new request
114will involve a new connection :
115
116 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
117
118In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
119establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
120by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
121length.
122
123Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
124to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
125however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
126response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
127header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
128
129 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
130
131Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
132power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
133but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200134a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200135
136A last improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
137keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
138second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
139page :
140
141 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
142
143This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
144latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
145correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
146the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100147server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200148
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200149By default HAProxy operates in a tunnel-like mode with regards to persistent
150connections: for each connection it processes the first request and forwards
151everything else (including additional requests) to selected server. Once
152established, the connection is persisted both on the client and server
153sides. Use "option http-server-close" to preserve client persistent connections
154while handling every incoming request individually, dispatching them one after
155another to servers, in HTTP close mode. Use "option httpclose" to switch both
156sides to HTTP close mode. "option forceclose" and "option
157http-pretend-keepalive" help working around servers misbehaving in HTTP close
158mode.
159
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200160
1611.2. HTTP request
162-----------------
163
164First, let's consider this HTTP request :
165
166 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100167 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200168 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
169 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
170 3 User-agent: my small browser
171 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
172 5 Accept: image/png
173
174
1751.2.1. The Request line
176-----------------------
177
178Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
179
180 - a METHOD : GET
181 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
182 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
183
184All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
185which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
186followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
187is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
188desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
189the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
190
191The URI itself can have several forms :
192
193 - A "relative URI" :
194
195 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
196
197 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
198 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
199
200 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
201
202 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
203
204 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
205 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
206 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
207 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
208 must accept this form too.
209
210 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
211 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
212 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100213
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200214 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
215 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
216 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
217 other protocols too.
218
219In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
220mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
221on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
222It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
223specific to the language, framework or application in use.
224
225
2261.2.2. The request headers
227--------------------------
228
229The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
230beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
231an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
232Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
233values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
234encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
235the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
236define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
237
238Contrary to a common mis-conception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
239their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
240"Connection:" header).
241
242The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
243that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
244is one valid form of empty line.
245
246Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
247headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
248about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
249application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
250
251Important note:
252 As suggested by RFC2616, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
253 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
254 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
255 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
256
257
2581.3. HTTP response
259------------------
260
261An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
262messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
263
264 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100265 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200266 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
267 2 Content-length: 350
268 3 Content-Type: text/html
269
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200270As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
271codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
272response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100273continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
274the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
275following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
276sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
277(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
278correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
279such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
280state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
281over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
282if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
283information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200284
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200285
2861.3.1. The Response line
287------------------------
288
289Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
290
291 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
292 - a status code : 200
293 - a reason : OK
294
295The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200296 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (eg: 100, 101)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200297 - 2xx = OK, content is following (eg: 200, 206)
298 - 3xx = OK, no content following (eg: 302, 304)
299 - 4xx = error caused by the client (eg: 401, 403, 404)
300 - 5xx = error caused by the server (eg: 500, 502, 503)
301
302Please refer to RFC2616 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100303"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200304found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
305messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
306or "Authentication Required".
307
308Haproxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
309
310 Code When / reason
311 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
312 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
313 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
314 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
315 400 for an invalid or too large request
316 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
317 accessing the stats page)
318 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
319 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
320 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
321 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
322 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
323 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
324 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
325 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
326 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
327
328The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3294.2).
330
331
3321.3.2. The response headers
333---------------------------
334
335Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
336the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
337details.
338
339
3402. Configuring HAProxy
341----------------------
342
3432.1. Configuration file format
344------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200345
346HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
347
348 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
349 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
350 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
351 "frontend" and "backend".
352
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100353The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
354referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
355delimited by spaces. If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100356preceded by a backslash ('\') to be escaped. Backslashes also have to be
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100357escaped by doubling them.
358
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200359
3602.2. Time format
361----------------
362
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100363Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100364values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
365otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
366numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
367for every keyword. Supported units are :
368
369 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
370 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
371 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
372 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
373 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
374 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
375
376
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +02003772.3. Examples
378-------------
379
380 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
381 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
382 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
383 global
384 daemon
385 maxconn 256
386
387 defaults
388 mode http
389 timeout connect 5000ms
390 timeout client 50000ms
391 timeout server 50000ms
392
393 frontend http-in
394 bind *:80
395 default_backend servers
396
397 backend servers
398 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
399
400
401 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
402 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
403 global
404 daemon
405 maxconn 256
406
407 defaults
408 mode http
409 timeout connect 5000ms
410 timeout client 50000ms
411 timeout server 50000ms
412
413 listen http-in
414 bind *:80
415 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
416
417
418Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
419
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100420 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200421
422
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004233. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200424--------------------
425
426Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
427are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
428of them have command-line equivalents.
429
430The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
431
432 * Process management and security
433 - chroot
434 - daemon
435 - gid
436 - group
437 - log
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100438 - log-send-hostname
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200439 - nbproc
440 - pidfile
441 - uid
442 - ulimit-n
443 - user
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200444 - stats
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200445 - node
446 - description
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100447 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100448
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200449 * Performance tuning
450 - maxconn
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100451 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200452 - noepoll
453 - nokqueue
454 - nopoll
455 - nosepoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100456 - nosplice
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200457 - spread-checks
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200458 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200459 - tune.chksize
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100460 - tune.maxaccept
461 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200462 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100463 - tune.rcvbuf.client
464 - tune.rcvbuf.server
465 - tune.sndbuf.client
466 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100467
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200468 * Debugging
469 - debug
470 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200471
472
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004733.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200474------------------------------------
475
476chroot <jail dir>
477 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
478 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
479 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
480 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
481 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
482 empty and unwritable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100483
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200484daemon
485 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
486 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
487 disabled by the command line "-db" argument.
488
489gid <number>
490 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
491 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
492 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
493 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100494
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200495group <group name>
496 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
497 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100498
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200499log <address> <facility> [max level [min level]]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200500 Adds a global syslog server. Up to two global servers can be defined. They
501 will receive logs for startups and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100502 configured with "log global".
503
504 <address> can be one of:
505
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100506 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100507 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
508 port).
509
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100510 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
511 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
512 port).
513
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100514 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
515 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
516 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
517 writeable).
518
519 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200520
521 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
522 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
523 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
524
525 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200526 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
527 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
528 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
529 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
530 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
531 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200532
533 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
534
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100535log-send-hostname [<string>]
536 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
537 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
538 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
539 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
540 the logs.
541
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000542log-tag <string>
543 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
544 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
545 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
546 running on the same host.
547
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200548nbproc <number>
549 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
550 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
551 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
552 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
553 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon".
554
555pidfile <pidfile>
556 Writes pids of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
557 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
558 starting the process. See also "daemon".
559
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200560stats socket <path> [{uid | user} <uid>] [{gid | group} <gid>] [mode <mode>]
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200561 [level <level>]
562
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200563 Creates a UNIX socket in stream mode at location <path>. Any previously
564 existing socket will be backed up then replaced. Connections to this socket
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100565 will return various statistics outputs and even allow some commands to be
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200566 issued. Please consult section 9.2 "Unix Socket commands" for more details.
567
568 An optional "level" parameter can be specified to restrict the nature of
569 the commands that can be issued on the socket :
570 - "user" is the least privileged level ; only non-sensitive stats can be
571 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
572 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
573
574 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
575 be read, and only non-sensible changes are permitted (eg: clear max
576 counters).
577
578 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (eg: clear
579 all counters).
Willy Tarreaua8efd362008-01-03 10:19:15 +0100580
581 On platforms which support it, it is possible to restrict access to this
582 socket by specifying numerical IDs after "uid" and "gid", or valid user and
583 group names after the "user" and "group" keywords. It is also possible to
584 restrict permissions on the socket by passing an octal value after the "mode"
585 keyword (same syntax as chmod). Depending on the platform, the permissions on
586 the socket will be inherited from the directory which hosts it, or from the
587 user the process is started with.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200588
589stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
590 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
591 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +0100592 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200593
594stats maxconn <connections>
595 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
596 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
597
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200598uid <number>
599 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
600 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
601 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
602 one. See also "gid" and "user".
603
604ulimit-n <number>
605 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
606 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
607 option.
608
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100609unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
610 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
611
612 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
613 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
614 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
615 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
616 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
617 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
618 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
619 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
620 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
621 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
622
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200623user <user name>
624 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
625 See also "uid" and "group".
626
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200627node <name>
628 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
629
630 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
631 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
632 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
633 traffic.
634
635description <text>
636 Add a text that describes the instance.
637
638 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
639 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
640 "<" and ">" characters.
641
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200642
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006433.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200644-----------------------
645
646maxconn <number>
647 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
648 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
649 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
650 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n".
651
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100652maxpipes <number>
653 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
654 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
655 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
656 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
657 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
658 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
659
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200660noepoll
661 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
662 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
663 used will generally be "poll". See also "nosepoll", and "nopoll".
664
665nokqueue
666 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
667 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
668 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
669
670nopoll
671 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
672 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100673 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200674 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nosepoll", and "nopoll" and
675 "nokqueue".
676
677nosepoll
678 Disables the use of the "speculative epoll" event polling system on Linux. It
679 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-ds". The next polling system
680 used will generally be "epoll". See also "nosepoll", and "nopoll".
681
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100682nosplice
683 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
684 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
685 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100686 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100687 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
688 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
689 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
690 "option splice-response".
691
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200692spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
693 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending health checks to servers at exact
694 intervals, for instance when many logical servers are located on the same
695 physical server. With the help of this parameter, it becomes possible to add
696 some randomness in the check interval between 0 and +/- 50%. A value between
697 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The default value remains at 0.
698
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200699tune.bufsize <number>
700 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
701 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
702 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
703 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
704 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
705 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
706 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
707 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased.
708
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200709tune.chksize <number>
710 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
711 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
712 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
713 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
714 checks whenever possible.
715
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100716tune.maxaccept <number>
717 Sets the maximum number of consecutive accepts that a process may perform on
718 a single wake up. High values give higher priority to high connection rates,
719 while lower values give higher priority to already established connections.
Willy Tarreauf49d1df2009-03-01 08:35:41 +0100720 This value is limited to 100 by default in single process mode. However, in
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100721 multi-process mode (nbproc > 1), it defaults to 8 so that when one process
722 wakes up, it does not take all incoming connections for itself and leaves a
Willy Tarreauf49d1df2009-03-01 08:35:41 +0100723 part of them to other processes. Setting this value to -1 completely disables
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100724 the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak this value.
725
726tune.maxpollevents <number>
727 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
728 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
729 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
730 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
731 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
732
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200733tune.maxrewrite <number>
734 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
735 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
736 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
737 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
738 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
739 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
740 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
741 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
742 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
743 bufsize.
744
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100745tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
746tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
747 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
748 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
749 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
750 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
751 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
752 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
753 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
754
755tune.sndbuf.client <number>
756tune.sndbuf.server <number>
757 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
758 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
759 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
760 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
761 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
762 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
763 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
764 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
765 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
766 notifying haproxy again.
767
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200768
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007693.3. Debugging
770--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200771
772debug
773 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
774 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
775 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
776 system startup.
777
778quiet
779 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
780 line argument "-q".
781
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200782
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01007833.4. Userlists
784--------------
785It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
786http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
787it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
788
789userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100790 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100791 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
792
793group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100794 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100795 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
796 proceeded by "users" keyword.
797
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100798user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
799 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100800 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
801 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100802 evaluated using the crypt(3) function so depending of the system's
803 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example modern Glibc
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100804 based Linux system supports MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512 and of course classic,
805 DES-based method of crypting passwords.
806
807
808 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100809 userlist L1
810 group G1 users tiger,scott
811 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100812
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100813 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
814 user scott insecure-password elgato
815 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100816
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100817 userlist L2
818 group G1
819 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100820
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100821 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
822 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
823 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100824
825 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200826
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200827
8283.5. Peers
829--------------
830It is possible to synchronize server entries in stick tables between several
831haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each instance
832pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. Server IDs are used to
833identify servers remotely, so it is important that configurations look similar
834or at least that the same IDs are forced on each server on all participants.
835Interrupted exchanges are automatically detected and recovered from the last
836known point. In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to
837the new one using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new
838process tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication
839during a reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large
840tables.
841
842peers <peersect>
843 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independant section,
844 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
845
846peer <peername> <ip>:<port>
847 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
848 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
849 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
850 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
851 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
852 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
853
854 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
855 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
856
857 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
858 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
859 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
860 across all peers.
861
862Example:
863 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +0100864 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
865 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
866 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200867
868 backend mybackend
869 mode tcp
870 balance roundrobin
871 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
872 stick on src
873
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +0100874 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
875 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200876
877
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008784. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200879----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100880
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200881Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
882 - defaults <name>
883 - frontend <name>
884 - backend <name>
885 - listen <name>
886
887A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
888its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
889section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100890section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200891
892A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
893connections.
894
895A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
896to forward incoming connections.
897
898A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
899parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
900
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100901All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
902'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
903case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
904
905Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
906logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
907proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
908However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
909name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
910
911Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
912and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100913bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100914protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
915modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
916arbitrary criteria.
917
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100918
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009194.1. Proxy keywords matrix
920--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100921
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200922The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
923limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
924they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
925limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100926marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, eg. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200927option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +0200928and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
929with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
930specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100931
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200932
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100933 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
934------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
935acl - X X X
936appsession - - X X
937backlog X X X -
938balance X - X X
939bind - X X -
940bind-process X X X X
941block - X X X
942capture cookie - X X -
943capture request header - X X -
944capture response header - X X -
945clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
946contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
947cookie X - X X
948default-server X - X X
949default_backend X X X -
950description - X X X
951disabled X X X X
952dispatch - - X X
953enabled X X X X
954errorfile X X X X
955errorloc X X X X
956errorloc302 X X X X
957-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
958errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +0200959force-persist - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100960fullconn X - X X
961grace X X X X
962hash-type X - X X
963http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +0100964http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +0200965http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100966http-request - X X X
967id - X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +0200968ignore-persist - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100969log X X X X
970maxconn X X X -
971mode X X X X
972monitor fail - X X -
973monitor-net X X X -
974monitor-uri X X X -
975option abortonclose (*) X - X X
976option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
977option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
978option allbackups (*) X - X X
979option checkcache (*) X - X X
980option clitcpka (*) X X X -
981option contstats (*) X X X -
982option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
983option dontlognull (*) X X X -
984option forceclose (*) X X X X
985-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
986option forwardfor X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +0200987option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +0200988option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100989option http-server-close (*) X X X X
990option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
991option httpchk X - X X
992option httpclose (*) X X X X
993option httplog X X X X
994option http_proxy (*) X X X X
995option independant-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +0200996option ldap-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100997option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
998option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
999option logasap (*) X X X -
1000option mysql-check X - X X
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01001001option pgsql-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001002option nolinger (*) X X X X
1003option originalto X X X X
1004option persist (*) X - X X
1005option redispatch (*) X - X X
1006option smtpchk X - X X
1007option socket-stats (*) X X X -
1008option splice-auto (*) X X X X
1009option splice-request (*) X X X X
1010option splice-response (*) X X X X
1011option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
1012option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
1013-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1014option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
1015option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
1016option tcpka X X X X
1017option tcplog X X X X
1018option transparent (*) X - X X
1019persist rdp-cookie X - X X
1020rate-limit sessions X X X -
1021redirect - X X X
1022redisp (deprecated) X - X X
1023redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
1024reqadd - X X X
1025reqallow - X X X
1026reqdel - X X X
1027reqdeny - X X X
1028reqiallow - X X X
1029reqidel - X X X
1030reqideny - X X X
1031reqipass - X X X
1032reqirep - X X X
1033reqisetbe - X X X
1034reqitarpit - X X X
1035reqpass - X X X
1036reqrep - X X X
1037-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1038reqsetbe - X X X
1039reqtarpit - X X X
1040retries X - X X
1041rspadd - X X X
1042rspdel - X X X
1043rspdeny - X X X
1044rspidel - X X X
1045rspideny - X X X
1046rspirep - X X X
1047rsprep - X X X
1048server - - X X
1049source X - X X
1050srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02001051stats admin - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001052stats auth X - X X
1053stats enable X - X X
1054stats hide-version X - X X
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02001055stats http-request - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001056stats realm X - X X
1057stats refresh X - X X
1058stats scope X - X X
1059stats show-desc X - X X
1060stats show-legends X - X X
1061stats show-node X - X X
1062stats uri X - X X
1063-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1064stick match - - X X
1065stick on - - X X
1066stick store-request - - X X
1067stick-table - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02001068tcp-request connection - X X -
1069tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02001070tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02001071tcp-response content - - X X
1072tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001073timeout check X - X X
1074timeout client X X X -
1075timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
1076timeout connect X - X X
1077timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1078timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
1079timeout http-request X X X X
1080timeout queue X - X X
1081timeout server X - X X
1082timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1083timeout tarpit X X X X
1084transparent (deprecated) X - X X
1085use_backend - X X -
1086------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1087 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001088
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001089
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010904.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
1091---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001092
1093This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
1094
1095
1096acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
1097 Declare or complete an access list.
1098 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1099 no | yes | yes | yes
1100 Example:
1101 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1102 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1103 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1104
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001105 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001106
1107
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001108appsession <cookie> len <length> timeout <holdtime>
1109 [request-learn] [prefix] [mode <path-parameters|query-string>]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001110 Define session stickiness on an existing application cookie.
1111 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1112 no | no | yes | yes
1113 Arguments :
1114 <cookie> this is the name of the cookie used by the application and which
1115 HAProxy will have to learn for each new session.
1116
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001117 <length> this is the max number of characters that will be memorized and
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001118 checked in each cookie value.
1119
1120 <holdtime> this is the time after which the cookie will be removed from
1121 memory if unused. If no unit is specified, this time is in
1122 milliseconds.
1123
Cyril Bontébf47aeb2009-10-15 00:15:40 +02001124 request-learn
1125 If this option is specified, then haproxy will be able to learn
1126 the cookie found in the request in case the server does not
1127 specify any in response. This is typically what happens with
1128 PHPSESSID cookies, or when haproxy's session expires before
1129 the application's session and the correct server is selected.
1130 It is recommended to specify this option to improve reliability.
1131
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001132 prefix When this option is specified, haproxy will match on the cookie
1133 prefix (or URL parameter prefix). The appsession value is the
1134 data following this prefix.
1135
1136 Example :
1137 appsession ASPSESSIONID len 64 timeout 3h prefix
1138
1139 This will match the cookie ASPSESSIONIDXXXX=XXXXX,
1140 the appsession value will be XXXX=XXXXX.
1141
1142 mode This option allows to change the URL parser mode.
1143 2 modes are currently supported :
1144 - path-parameters :
1145 The parser looks for the appsession in the path parameters
1146 part (each parameter is separated by a semi-colon), which is
1147 convenient for JSESSIONID for example.
1148 This is the default mode if the option is not set.
1149 - query-string :
1150 In this mode, the parser will look for the appsession in the
1151 query string.
1152
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001153 When an application cookie is defined in a backend, HAProxy will check when
1154 the server sets such a cookie, and will store its value in a table, and
1155 associate it with the server's identifier. Up to <length> characters from
1156 the value will be retained. On each connection, haproxy will look for this
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001157 cookie both in the "Cookie:" headers, and as a URL parameter (depending on
1158 the mode used). If a known value is found, the client will be directed to the
1159 server associated with this value. Otherwise, the load balancing algorithm is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001160 applied. Cookies are automatically removed from memory when they have been
1161 unused for a duration longer than <holdtime>.
1162
1163 The definition of an application cookie is limited to one per backend.
1164
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001165 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
1166 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
1167 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
1168
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001169 Example :
1170 appsession JSESSIONID len 52 timeout 3h
1171
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001172 See also : "cookie", "capture cookie", "balance", "stick", "stick-table",
1173 "ignore-persist", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001174
1175
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001176backlog <conns>
1177 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
1178 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1179 yes | yes | yes | no
1180 Arguments :
1181 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
1182 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
1183 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
1184
1185 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
1186 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
1187 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
1188 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
1189 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
1190 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
1191 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
1192 backlog parameter.
1193
1194 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
1195 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
1196 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
1197
1198 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
1199
1200
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001201balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001202balance url_param <param> [check_post [<max_wait>]]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001203 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
1204 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1205 yes | no | yes | yes
1206 Arguments :
1207 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
1208 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
1209 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
1210 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
1211
1212 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1213 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
1214 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
1215 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02001216 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
1217 design to 4128 active servers per backend. Note that in some
1218 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
1219 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
1220 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
1221 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
1222 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
1223 it, so that you don't worry.
1224
1225 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1226 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
1227 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
1228 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
1229 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
1230 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
1231 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
1232 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001233
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01001234 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
1235 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
1236 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
1237 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
1238 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
1239 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
1240 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
1241 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
1242
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001243 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
1244 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
1245 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
1246 address will always reach the same server as long as no
1247 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
1248 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
1249 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
1250 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001251 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001252 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001253 static by default, which means that changing a server's
1254 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
1255 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001256
1257 uri The left part of the URI (before the question mark) is hashed
1258 and divided by the total weight of the running servers. The
1259 result designates which server will receive the request. This
1260 ensures that a same URI will always be directed to the same
1261 server as long as no server goes up or down. This is used
1262 with proxy caches and anti-virus proxies in order to maximize
1263 the cache hit rate. Note that this algorithm may only be used
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001264 in an HTTP backend. This algorithm is static by default,
1265 which means that changing a server's weight on the fly will
1266 have no effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001267
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001268 This algorithm support two optional parameters "len" and
1269 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
1270 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
1271 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
1272 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
1273 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
1274 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
1275 URIs start with a leading "/".
1276
1277 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
1278 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
1279 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
1280 evaluation stops when either is reached.
1281
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001282 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001283 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
1284
1285 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
1286 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
Willy Tarreau61a21a32011-03-01 20:35:49 +01001287 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
1288 ('?') in the URL. Optionally, specify a number of octets to
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001289 wait for before attempting to search the message body. If the
1290 entity can not be searched, then round robin is used for each
1291 request. For instance, if your clients always send the LB
1292 parameter in the first 128 bytes, then specify that. The
1293 default is 48. The entity data will not be scanned until the
1294 required number of octets have arrived at the gateway, this
1295 is the minimum of: (default/max_wait, Content-Length or first
1296 chunk length). If Content-Length is missing or zero, it does
1297 not need to wait for more data than the client promised to
1298 send. When Content-Length is present and larger than
1299 <max_wait>, then waiting is limited to <max_wait> and it is
1300 assumed that this will be enough data to search for the
1301 presence of the parameter. In the unlikely event that
1302 Transfer-Encoding: chunked is used, only the first chunk is
1303 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
1304 be randomly balanced if at all.
1305
1306 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
1307 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
1308 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
1309 server will receive the request.
1310
1311 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
1312 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
1313 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
1314 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
1315 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001316 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
1317 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
1318 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001319
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001320 hdr(name) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP request.
1321 Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function, the header
1322 name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the header is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001323 absent or if it does not contain any value, the roundrobin
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001324 algorithm is applied instead.
1325
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001326 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001327 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
1328 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
1329 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
1330
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001331 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1332 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1333 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1334
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001335 rdp-cookie
1336 rdp-cookie(name)
1337 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
1338 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
1339 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
1340 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
1341 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
1342 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001343 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001344 used instead.
1345
1346 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
1347 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
1348 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
1349 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
1350
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001351 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1352 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1353 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1354
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001355 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001356 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
1357 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001358
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001359 balance uri [len <len>] [depth <depth>]
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001360 balance url_param <param> [check_post [<max_wait>]]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001361
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01001362 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
1363 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
1364 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001365
1366 Examples :
1367 balance roundrobin
1368 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001369 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001370 balance hdr(User-Agent)
1371 balance hdr(host)
1372 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001373
1374 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
1375 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
1376
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001377 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001378 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
1379 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
1380 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
1381 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
1382
1383 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
1384 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
1385 defaults to 16 kB.
1386
1387 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
1388 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
1389
1390 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
1391 Round Robin.
1392
1393 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC2616 3.6.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
1394 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
1395 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
1396 actually appeared in the first chunk).
1397
1398 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
1399
1400 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001401 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001402 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
1403 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
1404 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001405
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001406 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "appsession", "transparent", "hash-type" and
1407 "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001408
1409
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001410bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...]
1411bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] interface <interface>
1412bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] mss <maxseg>
1413bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] transparent
1414bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] id <id>
1415bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] name <name>
1416bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] defer-accept
Willy Tarreau71c814e2010-10-29 21:56:16 +02001417bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] accept-proxy
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001418bind /<path> [, ...]
1419bind /<path> [, ...] mode <mode>
1420bind /<path> [, ...] [ user <user> | uid <uid> ]
1421bind /<path> [, ...] [ group <user> | gid <gid> ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001422 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
1423 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1424 no | yes | yes | no
1425 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001426 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
1427 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
1428 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
1429 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01001430 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001431
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001432 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
1433 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001434 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
1435 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
1436 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001437 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
1438 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
1439 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
1440 the range.
1441
1442 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
1443 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
1444 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
1445 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
1446 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
1447 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
1448 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
1449 privileges to start the program, which are independant of
1450 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001451
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001452 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
1453 alternative to the TCP listening port. Haproxy will then
1454 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
1455 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
1456 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
1457 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
1458 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
1459 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
1460
Willy Tarreau5e6e2042009-02-04 17:19:29 +01001461 <interface> is an optional physical interface name. This is currently
1462 only supported on Linux. The interface must be a physical
1463 interface, not an aliased interface. When specified, all
1464 addresses on the same line will only be accepted if the
1465 incoming packet physically come through the designated
1466 interface. It is also possible to bind multiple frontends to
1467 the same address if they are bound to different interfaces.
1468 Note that binding to a physical interface requires root
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001469 privileges. This parameter is only compatible with TCP
1470 sockets.
Willy Tarreau5e6e2042009-02-04 17:19:29 +01001471
Willy Tarreaube1b9182009-06-14 18:48:19 +02001472 <maxseg> is an optional TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be
1473 advertised on incoming connections. This can be used to force
1474 a lower MSS for certain specific ports, for instance for
1475 connections passing through a VPN. Note that this relies on a
1476 kernel feature which is theorically supported under Linux but
1477 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not
Willy Tarreau48a7e722010-12-24 15:26:39 +01001478 work on other operating systems. It may also not change the
1479 advertised value but change the effective size of outgoing
1480 segments. The commonly advertised value on Ethernet networks
1481 is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is positive,
1482 it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it
1483 will indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's
1484 advertised MSS for outgoing segments. This parameter is only
1485 compatible with TCP sockets.
Willy Tarreaube1b9182009-06-14 18:48:19 +02001486
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02001487 <id> is a persistent value for socket ID. Must be positive and
1488 unique in the proxy. An unused value will automatically be
1489 assigned if unset. Can only be used when defining only a
1490 single socket.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02001491
1492 <name> is an optional name provided for stats
1493
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001494 <mode> is the octal mode used to define access permissions on the
1495 UNIX socket. It can also be set by default in the global
1496 section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that some platforms
1497 simply ignore this.
1498
1499 <user> is the name of user that will be marked owner of the UNIX
1500 socket. It can also be set by default in the global
1501 section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that some platforms
1502 simply ignore this.
1503
1504 <group> is the name of a group that will be used to create the UNIX
1505 socket. It can also be set by default in the global section's
1506 "unix-bind" statement. Note that some platforms simply ignore
1507 this.
1508
1509 <uid> is the uid of user that will be marked owner of the UNIX
1510 socket. It can also be set by default in the global section's
1511 "unix-bind" statement. Note that some platforms simply ignore
1512 this.
1513
1514 <gid> is the gid of a group that will be used to create the UNIX
1515 socket. It can also be set by default in the global section's
1516 "unix-bind" statement. Note that some platforms simply ignore
1517 this.
1518
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001519 transparent is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain
1520 Linux kernels. It indicates that the addresses will be bound
1521 even if they do not belong to the local machine. Any packet
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001522 targeting any of these addresses will be caught just as if
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001523 the address was locally configured. This normally requires
1524 that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with
1525 the default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for
1526 the specified port. This keyword is available only when
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001527 HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1. This parameter is
1528 only compatible with TCP sockets.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001529
Willy Tarreau59f89202010-10-02 11:54:00 +02001530 defer-accept is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain
Willy Tarreaucb6cd432009-10-13 07:34:14 +02001531 Linux kernels. It states that a connection will only be
1532 accepted once some data arrive on it, or at worst after the
1533 first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols for
1534 which the client talks first (eg: HTTP). It can slightly
1535 improve performance by ensuring that most of the request is
1536 already available when the connection is accepted. On the
1537 other hand, it will not be able to detect connections which
1538 don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
1539 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is
1540 never accepted until the client talks. This can cause issues
1541 with front firewalls which would see an established
1542 connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV.
1543
Willy Tarreau71c814e2010-10-29 21:56:16 +02001544 accept-proxy is an optional keyword which enforces use of the PROXY
1545 protocol over any connection accepted by this listener. The
1546 PROXY protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of the
1547 incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used,
1548 with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules
1549 which will only see the real connection address. Logs will
1550 reflect the addresses indicated in the protocol, unless it is
1551 violated, in which case the real address will still be used.
1552 This keyword combined with support from external components
1553 can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
1554 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and
1555 not even always usable.
1556
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001557 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
1558 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
1559 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
1560 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
1561 in a frontend.
1562
1563 Example :
1564 listen http_proxy
1565 bind :80,:443
1566 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001567 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001568
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001569 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreau71c814e2010-10-29 21:56:16 +02001570 documentation.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001571
1572
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001573bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-32> ] ...
1574 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
1575 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1576 yes | yes | yes | yes
1577 Arguments :
1578 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
1579 may be used to override a default value.
1580
1581 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...31. This
1582 option may be combined with other numbers.
1583
1584 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...32. This
1585 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
1586 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
1587 missing from all processes.
1588
1589 number The instance will be enabled on this process number, between
1590 1 and 32. You must be careful not to reference a process
1591 number greater than the configured global.nbproc, otherwise
1592 some instances might be missing from all processes.
1593
1594 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
1595 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
1596 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
1597 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
1598 and 'even' instances.
1599
1600 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 processes using
1601 this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups. Please
1602 note that 'all' really means all processes and is not limited to the first
1603 32.
1604
1605 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
1606 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
1607
1608 Example :
1609 listen app_ip1
1610 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001611 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001612
1613 listen app_ip2
1614 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001615 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001616
1617 listen management
1618 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001619 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001620
1621 See also : "nbproc" in global section.
1622
1623
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001624block { if | unless } <condition>
1625 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
1626 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1627 no | yes | yes | yes
1628
1629 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
1630 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001631 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001632 typically used to deny access to certain sensible resources if some
1633 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
1634 "block" statements per instance.
1635
1636 Example:
1637 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1638 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1639 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1640 block if invalid_src || local_dst
1641
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001642 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001643
1644
1645capture cookie <name> len <length>
1646 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
1647 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1648 no | yes | yes | no
1649 Arguments :
1650 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
1651 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
1652 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
1653 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
1654 and value (eg: ASPSESSIONXXXXX).
1655
1656 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
1657 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
1658 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
1659 right if it exceeds <length>.
1660
1661 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
1662 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
1663 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
1664 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
1665
1666 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
1667 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
1668 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
1669
1670 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
1671 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
1672 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
1673 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001674 configured in the sources by default to 64 characters. It is not possible to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001675 specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
1676
1677 Example:
1678 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
1679
1680 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001681 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001682
1683
1684capture request header <name> len <length>
1685 Capture and log the first occurrence of the specified request header.
1686 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1687 no | yes | yes | no
1688 Arguments :
1689 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001690 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001691 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
1692 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
1693 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
1694
1695 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
1696 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
1697 it exceeds <length>.
1698
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001699 Only the first value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001700 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
1701 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001702 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
1703 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
1704 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
1705 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001706 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001707 environments to find where the request came from.
1708
1709 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
1710 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
1711 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
1712 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001713
1714 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers, but each capture
1715 is limited to 64 characters. In order to keep log format consistent for a
1716 same frontend, header captures can only be declared in a frontend. It is not
1717 possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
1718
1719 Example:
1720 capture request header Host len 15
1721 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
1722 capture request header Referrer len 15
1723
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001724 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001725 about logging.
1726
1727
1728capture response header <name> len <length>
1729 Capture and log the first occurrence of the specified response header.
1730 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1731 no | yes | yes | no
1732 Arguments :
1733 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001734 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001735 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
1736 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
1737 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
1738
1739 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
1740 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
1741 it exceeds <length>.
1742
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001743 Only the first value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001744 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
1745 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
1746 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001747 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
1748 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
1749 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
1750 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001751
1752 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers, but each
1753 capture is limited to 64 characters. In order to keep log format consistent
1754 for a same frontend, header captures can only be declared in a frontend. It
1755 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
1756
1757 Example:
1758 capture response header Content-length len 9
1759 capture response header Location len 15
1760
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001761 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001762 about logging.
1763
1764
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001765clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001766 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
1767 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1768 yes | yes | yes | no
1769 Arguments :
1770 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
1771 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
1772 as explained at the top of this document.
1773
1774 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
1775 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
1776 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
1777 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
1778 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
1779 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
1780 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
1781 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001782 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001783 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
1784 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds).
1785
1786 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
1787 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
1788 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
1789 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
1790 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
1791 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
1792
1793 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
1794 Please use "timeout client" instead.
1795
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01001796 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
1797 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001798
1799
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001800contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001801 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
1802 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1803 yes | no | yes | yes
1804 Arguments :
1805 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
1806 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
1807 as explained at the top of this document.
1808
1809 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001810 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001811 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001812 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
1813 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
1814 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
1815 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
1816
1817 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
1818 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
1819 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
1820 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
1821 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
1822 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
1823
1824 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
1825 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
1826 instead.
1827
1828 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
1829 "timeout server", "contimeout".
1830
1831
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02001832cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02001833 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ domain <domain> ]*
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02001834 [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001835 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
1836 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1837 yes | no | yes | yes
1838 Arguments :
1839 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
1840 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
1841 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
1842 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
1843 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
1844 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
1845 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (eg:
1846 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
1847 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
1848
1849 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
1850 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
1851 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
1852 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
1853 headers is left to the application. The application can then
1854 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
1855 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode only
1856 works in HTTP close mode. Unless the application behaviour is
1857 very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to start with this
1858 mode for new deployments. This keyword is incompatible with
1859 "insert" and "prefix".
1860
1861 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02001862 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02001863
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02001864 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02001865 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
1866 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be remove before
1867 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
1868 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
1869 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
1870 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
1871 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
1872 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
1873 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
1874 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001875
1876 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
1877 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
1878 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
1879 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
1880 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
1881 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
1882 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
1883 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
1884 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
1885 this mode requires the HTTP close mode. The "prefix" keyword is
1886 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert".
1887
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02001888 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
1889 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
1890 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02001891 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
1892 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
1893 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
1894 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001895
1896 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
1897 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
1898 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
1899 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
1900 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
1901 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
1902 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
1903 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
1904 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
1905
1906 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
1907 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
1908 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
1909 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
1910 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
1911 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
1912 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
1913 persistence cookie in the cache.
1914 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
1915
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02001916 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
1917 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
1918 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
1919 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
1920 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
1921 emit a cookie with an invalid value (eg: empty) or with a date in
1922 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
1923 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
1924 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
1925 they logout.
1926
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02001927 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001928 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01001929 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
1930 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
1931 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
1932 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
1933 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
1934 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02001935
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02001936 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
1937 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
1938 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
1939 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
1940 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
1941 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
1942 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
1943 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
1944 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). When
1945 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
1946 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
1947 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
1948 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
1949 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
1950 the site.
1951
1952 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
1953 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
1954 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
1955 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
1956 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
1957 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
1958 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
1959 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
1960 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
1961 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
1962 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
1963 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
1964 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
1965 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). This
1966 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
1967 redispatch after some absolute delay.
1968
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001969 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
1970 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
1971 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
1972 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001973
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001974 Examples :
1975 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
1976 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
1977 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02001978 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001979
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02001980 See also : "appsession", "balance source", "capture cookie", "server"
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001981 and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001982
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01001983
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01001984default-server [param*]
1985 Change default options for a server in a backend
1986 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1987 yes | no | yes | yes
1988 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01001989 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
1990 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
1991 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
1992 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01001993
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01001994 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01001995 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
1996
1997 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001998
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01001999
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002000default_backend <backend>
2001 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
2002 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2003 yes | yes | yes | no
2004 Arguments :
2005 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
2006
2007 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
2008 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
2009 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
2010 will catch all undetermined requests.
2011
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002012 Example :
2013
2014 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
2015 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
2016 default_backend dynamic
2017
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002018 See also : "use_backend", "reqsetbe", "reqisetbe"
2019
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002020
2021disabled
2022 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2023 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2024 yes | yes | yes | yes
2025 Arguments : none
2026
2027 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
2028 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
2029 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
2030 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
2031 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
2032 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
2033 keyword in a "defaults" section.
2034
2035 See also : "enabled"
2036
2037
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002038dispatch <address>:<port>
2039 Set a default server address
2040 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2041 no | no | yes | yes
2042 Arguments : none
2043
2044 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
2045 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
2046 during start-up.
2047
2048 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
2049 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
2050 possible with normal servers.
2051
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02002052 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002053 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
2054 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
2055 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
2056 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
2057
2058 See also : "server"
2059
2060
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002061enabled
2062 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2063 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2064 yes | yes | yes | yes
2065 Arguments : none
2066
2067 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
2068 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
2069
2070 See also : "disabled"
2071
2072
2073errorfile <code> <file>
2074 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2075 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2076 yes | yes | yes | yes
2077 Arguments :
2078 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002079 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002080
2081 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002082 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002083 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002084 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
2085 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002086
2087 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2088 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2089 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2090
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002091 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2092
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002093 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
2094 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
2095 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
2096 files returning the same contents as default errors.
2097
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002098 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
2099 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
2100 not to put any reference to local contents (eg: images) in order to avoid
2101 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
2102 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
2103 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
2104
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002105 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
2106 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
2107 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01002108 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002109 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
2110
2111 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
2112
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002113 Example :
2114 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
2115 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
2116 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
2117
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002118
2119errorloc <code> <url>
2120errorloc302 <code> <url>
2121 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2122 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2123 yes | yes | yes | yes
2124 Arguments :
2125 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002126 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002127
2128 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2129 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2130 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2131 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2132 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2133
2134 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2135 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2136 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2137
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002138 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2139
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002140 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
2141 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
2142 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
2143 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
2144 workaround this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
2145 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
2146 request.
2147
2148 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
2149
2150
2151errorloc303 <code> <url>
2152 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2153 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2154 yes | yes | yes | yes
2155 Arguments :
2156 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
2157 generating codes 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
2158
2159 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2160 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2161 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2162 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2163 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2164
2165 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2166 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2167 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2168
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002169 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2170
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002171 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
2172 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
2173 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
2174 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002175 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002176
2177 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
2178
2179
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002180force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
2181 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
2182 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2183 no | yes | yes | yes
2184
2185 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
2186 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
2187 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
2188 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
2189 marked down for maintenance operations.
2190
2191 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
2192 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
2193 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
2194 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
2195 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
2196 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
2197 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
2198 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
2199 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
2200
2201 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
2202 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
2203 is used.
2204
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002205 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002206 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002207
2208
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002209fullconn <conns>
2210 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
2211 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2212 yes | no | yes | yes
2213 Arguments :
2214 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
2215 servers use the maximal number of connections.
2216
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002217 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002218 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002219 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002220 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
2221 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
2222 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
2223 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
2224 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002225 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002226
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02002227 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
2228 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
2229 backend. That way it's safe to leave it unset.
2230
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002231 Example :
2232 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
2233 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
2234 # connections.
2235 backend dynamic
2236 fullconn 10000
2237 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2238 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2239
2240 See also : "maxconn", "server"
2241
2242
2243grace <time>
2244 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
2245 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01002246 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002247 Arguments :
2248 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
2249 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
2250 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
2251
2252 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
2253 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002254 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002255 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
2256
2257 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
2258 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
2259 simplify it.
2260
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002261
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002262hash-type <method>
2263 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
2264 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2265 yes | no | yes | yes
2266 Arguments :
2267 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
2268 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but will
2269 be static in that weight changes while a server is up will be
2270 ignored. This means that there will be no slow start. Also,
2271 since a server is selected by its position in the array, most
2272 mappings are changed when the server count changes. This means
2273 that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is added
2274 to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to different
2275 servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for instance.
2276
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01002277 avalanche this mechanism uses the default map-based hashing described
2278 above but applies a full avalanche hash before performing the
2279 mapping. The result is a slightly less smooth hash for most
2280 situations, but the hash becomes better than pure map-based
2281 hashes when the number of servers is a multiple of the size of
2282 the input set. When using URI hash with a number of servers
2283 multiple of 64, it's desirable to change the hash type to
2284 this value.
2285
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002286 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
2287 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
2288 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
2289 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
2290 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
2291 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a server
2292 is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings are
2293 redistributed, making it an ideal algorithm for caches.
2294 However, due to its principle, the algorithm will never be very
2295 smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a server's
2296 weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution. In order
2297 to get the same distribution on multiple load balancers, it is
2298 important that all servers have the same IDs.
2299
2300 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages.
2301
2302 See also : "balance", "server"
2303
2304
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002305http-check disable-on-404
2306 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
2307 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002308 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002309 Arguments : none
2310
2311 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
2312 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
2313 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
2314 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
2315 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
2316 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
2317 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
2318 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002319 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
2320 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
2321 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
2322
2323 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
2324
2325
2326http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
2327 Make HTTP health checks consider reponse contents or specific status codes
2328 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2329 no | no | yes | yes
2330 Arguments :
2331 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
2332 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
2333 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceeded by an
2334 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
2335 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
2336 details on the supported keywords.
2337
2338 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
2339 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
2340 with the usual backslash ('\').
2341
2342 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
2343 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
2344 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
2345 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
2346 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
2347
2348 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
2349 A health check respose will be considered valid if the
2350 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
2351 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2352 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2353
2354 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
2355 A health check respose will be considered valid if the
2356 response's status code matches the expression. If the
2357 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2358 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2359 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
2360
2361 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
2362 A health check respose will be considered valid if the
2363 response's body contains this exact string. If the
2364 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2365 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
2366 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
2367 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
2368 specific error appears on the check page (eg: a stack
2369 trace).
2370
2371 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
2372 A health check respose will be considered valid if the
2373 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
2374 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
2375 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
2376 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
2377 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
2378 error appears on the check page (eg: a stack trace).
2379
2380 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
2381 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
2382 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
2383 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
2384 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
2385 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
2386 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
2387 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
2388
2389 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
2390 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
2391
2392 Examples :
2393 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002394 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002395
2396 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002397 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002398
2399 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002400 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002401
2402 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002403 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*</html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002404
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002405 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002406
2407
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01002408http-check send-state
2409 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
2410 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2411 yes | no | yes | yes
2412 Arguments : none
2413
2414 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
2415 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
2416 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
2417 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
2418 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
2419
2420 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
2421 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
2422 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
2423 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
2424 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
2425 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
2426 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
2427 checked in multiple backends.
2428
2429 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
2430 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
2431
2432 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
2433 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
2434 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
2435 one fails.
2436
2437 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
2438 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
2439 connections on all servers of the same backend.
2440
2441 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
2442 server's queue.
2443
2444 Example of a header received by the application server :
2445 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
2446 scur=13/22; qcur=0
2447
2448 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
2449
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02002450http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002451 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002452 Access control for Layer 7 requests
2453
2454 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2455 no | yes | yes | yes
2456
2457 These set of options allow to fine control access to a
2458 frontend/listen/backend. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
2459 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02002460 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
2461 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002462 should be asked to enter a username and password.
2463
2464 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
2465 instance.
2466
2467 Example:
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002468 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
2469 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
2470 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002471
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002472 http-request allow if nagios
2473 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
2474 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
2475 http-request deny
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002476
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002477 Example:
2478 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002479
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002480 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002481
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02002482 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
2483 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01002484
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01002485id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02002486 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
2487 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2488 no | yes | yes | yes
2489 Arguments : none
2490
2491 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
2492 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
2493 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01002494
2495
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002496ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
2497 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
2498 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2499 no | yes | yes | yes
2500
2501 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
2502 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
2503 and running).
2504
2505 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
2506 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
2507 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
2508 oftenly don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
2509 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
2510
2511 Combined with "appsession", it can also help reduce HAProxy memory usage, as
2512 the appsession table won't grow if persistence is ignored.
2513
2514 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
2515 "unless" condition is met.
2516
2517 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
2518
2519
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002520log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02002521log <address> <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002522 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
2523 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2524 yes | yes | yes | yes
2525 Arguments :
2526 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
2527 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
2528 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
2529 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
2530 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
2531 parameter.
2532
2533 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
2534 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
2535
2536 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
2537 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
2538 standard syslog port).
2539
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01002540 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
2541 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
2542 standard syslog port).
2543
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002544 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
2545 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
2546 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
2547 appropriately writeable).
2548
2549 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
2550
2551 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
2552 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
2553 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
2554
2555 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
2556 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
2557 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02002558 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
2559 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
2560 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
2561 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
2562 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002563
2564 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
2565
2566 Note that up to two "log" entries may be specified per instance. However, if
2567 "log global" is used and if the "global" section already contains 2 log
2568 entries, then additional log entries will be ignored.
2569
2570 Also, it is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002571 what to log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log
2572 entries from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level
2573 "info".
2574
2575 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
2576 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
2577 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
2578 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
2579
2580 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
2581 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002582
2583 Example :
2584 log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02002585 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
2586 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002587
2588
2589maxconn <conns>
2590 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
2591 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2592 yes | yes | yes | no
2593 Arguments :
2594 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
2595 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
2596 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
2597 closes.
2598
2599 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
2600 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
2601 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
2602 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
2603 of 8kB each, as well as some other data resulting in about 17 kB of RAM being
2604 consumed per established connection. That means that a medium system equipped
2605 with 1GB of RAM can withstand around 40000-50000 concurrent connections if
2606 properly tuned.
2607
2608 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
2609 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
2610 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
2611
2612 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
2613
2614
2615mode { tcp|http|health }
2616 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
2617 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2618 yes | yes | yes | yes
2619 Arguments :
2620 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
2621 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
2622 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
2623 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
2624
2625 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
2626 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
2627 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
2628 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
2629 brings HAProxy most of its value.
2630
2631 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
2632 to incoming connections and close the connection. Nothing will be
2633 logged. This mode is used to reply to external components health
2634 checks. This mode is deprecated and should not be used anymore as
2635 it is possible to do the same and even better by combining TCP or
2636 HTTP modes with the "monitor" keyword.
2637
2638 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
2639 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
2640 will be refused.
2641
2642 Example :
2643 defaults http_instances
2644 mode http
2645
2646 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
2647
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002648
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002649monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002650 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002651 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2652 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002653 Arguments :
2654 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
2655 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002656 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002657 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
2658 backend and its backup.
2659
2660 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
2661 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
2662 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
2663 servers in a list of backends.
2664
2665 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
2666 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
2667 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
2668 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
2669 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
2670 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
2671 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002672 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
2673 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002674
2675 Example:
2676 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002677 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002678 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
2679 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
2680 monitor-uri /site_alive
2681 monitor fail if site_dead
2682
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002683 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002684
2685
2686monitor-net <source>
2687 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
2688 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2689 yes | yes | yes | no
2690 Arguments :
2691 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
2692 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
2693 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
2694 followed by a mask.
2695
2696 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
2697 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002698 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002699 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
2700
2701 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
2702 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
2703 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
2704 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
2705 running without forwarding the request to a backend server.
2706
2707 Monitor requests are processed very early. It is not possible to block nor
2708 divert them using ACLs. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
2709 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
2710 nothing more. Right now, it is not possible to set failure conditions on
2711 requests caught by "monitor-net".
2712
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01002713 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
2714 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
2715
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002716 Example :
2717 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
2718 frontend www
2719 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
2720
2721 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
2722
2723
2724monitor-uri <uri>
2725 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
2726 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2727 yes | yes | yes | no
2728 Arguments :
2729 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
2730 health status instead of forwarding the request.
2731
2732 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
2733 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
2734 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
2735 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
2736 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
2737 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
2738 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
2739 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
2740
2741 Monitor requests are processed very early. It is not possible to block nor
2742 divert them using ACLs. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
2743 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
2744 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
2745 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
2746 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
2747
2748 Example :
2749 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
2750 frontend www
2751 mode http
2752 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
2753
2754 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
2755
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002756
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002757option abortonclose
2758no option abortonclose
2759 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
2760 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2761 yes | no | yes | yes
2762 Arguments : none
2763
2764 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
2765 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
2766 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
2767 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002768 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002769 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
2770 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
2771 encountered while delivering the response.
2772
2773 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
2774 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
2775 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
2776 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
2777 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
2778 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002779 support this behaviour (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002780 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002781 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002782 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
2783 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
2784 still not served and not pollute the servers.
2785
2786 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behaviour using the option
2787 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behaviour is HTTP
2788 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
2789 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
2790 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
2791 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
2792 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
2793 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002794 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002795
2796 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2797 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2798
2799 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
2800
2801
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02002802option accept-invalid-http-request
2803no option accept-invalid-http-request
2804 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
2805 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2806 yes | yes | yes | no
2807 Arguments : none
2808
2809 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
2810 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
2811 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
2812 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
2813 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
2814 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
2815 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
2816 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
2817 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option.
2818
2819 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
2820 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
2821 been confirmed.
2822
2823 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
2824 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
2825 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Doing this
2826 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
2827
2828 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2829 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2830
2831 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
2832 stats socket.
2833
2834
2835option accept-invalid-http-response
2836no option accept-invalid-http-response
2837 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
2838 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2839 yes | no | yes | yes
2840 Arguments : none
2841
2842 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
2843 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
2844 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
2845 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
2846 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
2847 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
2848 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
2849 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
2850 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option.
2851
2852 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
2853 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
2854 been confirmed.
2855
2856 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
2857 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
2858 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
2859 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
2860
2861 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2862 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2863
2864 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
2865 stats socket.
2866
2867
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002868option allbackups
2869no option allbackups
2870 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
2871 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2872 yes | no | yes | yes
2873 Arguments : none
2874
2875 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
2876 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
2877 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
2878 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
2879 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
2880 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
2881 order between the backup servers anymore.
2882
2883 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
2884 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
2885
2886 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2887 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2888
2889
2890option checkcache
2891no option checkcache
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002892 Analyze all server responses and block requests with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002893 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2894 yes | no | yes | yes
2895 Arguments : none
2896
2897 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
2898 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002899 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002900 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
2901 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
2902 some sensible session information go in the wild.
2903
2904 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002905 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002906 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002907 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
2908 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002909 to the client are :
2910 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002911 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 206, 300, 301, 410,
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002912 provided that the server has not set a "Cache-control: public" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002913 - all those that come from a POST request, provided that the server has not
2914 set a 'Cache-Control: public' header ;
2915 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
2916 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
2917 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
2918 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
2919 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
2920 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
2921 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
2922 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
2923 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
2924
2925 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002926 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002927 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002928 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002929 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
2930
2931 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
2932 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002933 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002934 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviours.
2935
2936 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2937 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2938
2939
2940option clitcpka
2941no option clitcpka
2942 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
2943 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2944 yes | yes | yes | no
2945 Arguments : none
2946
2947 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
2948 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
2949 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
2950 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
2951
2952 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
2953 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
2954 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
2955 operating system and its tuning parameters.
2956
2957 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
2958 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
2959 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
2960 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
2961 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
2962
2963 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
2964
2965 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
2966 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
2967 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
2968
2969 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2970 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2971
2972 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
2973
2974
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002975option contstats
2976 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
2977 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2978 yes | yes | yes | no
2979 Arguments : none
2980
2981 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
2982 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
2983 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
2984 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
2985 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented continuously,
2986 during a whole session. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so
2987 it is not enabled by default, as it has small performance impact (~0.5%).
2988
2989
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02002990option dontlog-normal
2991no option dontlog-normal
2992 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
2993 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2994 yes | yes | yes | no
2995 Arguments : none
2996
2997 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
2998 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
2999 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
3000 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
3001 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
3002 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
3003 logged.
3004
3005 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
3006 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
3007 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
3008
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003009 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003010 logging.
3011
3012
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003013option dontlognull
3014no option dontlognull
3015 Enable or disable logging of null connections
3016 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3017 yes | yes | yes | no
3018 Arguments : none
3019
3020 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
3021 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
3022 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
3023 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
3024 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
3025 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
3026 which typically corresponds to those probes.
3027
3028 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
3029 environments (eg: internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
3030 would not be logged.
3031
3032 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3033 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3034
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003035 See also : "log", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003036
3037
3038option forceclose
3039no option forceclose
3040 Enable or disable active connection closing after response is transferred.
3041 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaua31e5df2009-12-30 01:10:35 +01003042 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003043 Arguments : none
3044
3045 Some HTTP servers do not necessarily close the connections when they receive
3046 the "Connection: close" set by "option httpclose", and if the client does not
3047 close either, then the connection remains open till the timeout expires. This
3048 causes high number of simultaneous connections on the servers and shows high
3049 global session times in the logs.
3050
3051 When this happens, it is possible to use "option forceclose". It will
Willy Tarreau82eeaf22009-12-29 12:09:05 +01003052 actively close the outgoing server channel as soon as the server has finished
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003053 to respond. This option implicitly enables the "httpclose" option. Note that
3054 this option also enables the parsing of the full request and response, which
3055 means we can close the connection to the server very quickly, releasing some
3056 resources earlier than with httpclose.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003057
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003058 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
3059 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
3060 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
3061
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003062 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3063 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3064
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003065 See also : "option httpclose" and "option http-pretend-keepalive"
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003066
3067
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003068option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003069 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
3070 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3071 yes | yes | yes | yes
3072 Arguments :
3073 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
3074 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003075 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003076 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003077
3078 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
3079 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
3080 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
3081 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
3082 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
3083 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
3084 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003085 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
3086 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
3087 possible that the client has already brought one.
3088
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003089 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003090 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003091 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (eg: stunnel),
3092 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003093 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (eg: Zeus Web Servers
3094 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003095
3096 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
3097 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
3098 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
3099 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
3100 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
3101 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
3102 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
3103
3104 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003105 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
3106 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
3107 both are defined.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003108
3109 It is important to note that as long as HAProxy does not support keep-alive
3110 connections, only the first request of a connection will receive the header.
3111 For this reason, it is important to ensure that "option httpclose" is set
3112 when using this option.
3113
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003114 Examples :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003115 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
3116 frontend www
3117 mode http
3118 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
3119
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003120 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
3121 backend www
3122 mode http
3123 option forwardfor header X-Client
3124
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003125 See also : "option httpclose"
3126
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003127
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02003128option http-no-delay
3129no option http-no-delay
3130 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
3131 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3132 yes | yes | yes | yes
3133 Arguments : none
3134
3135 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
3136 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
3137 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
3138 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
3139 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
3140 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
3141 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
3142 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
3143 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
3144 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
3145 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
3146 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
3147 affected.
3148
3149 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
3150 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
3151 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
3152 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
3153 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
3154 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
3155 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
3156 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
3157 latency environments.
3158
3159
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003160option http-pretend-keepalive
3161no option http-pretend-keepalive
3162 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
3163 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3164 yes | yes | yes | yes
3165 Arguments : none
3166
3167 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose", haproxy
3168 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
3169 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
3170 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
3171 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
3172 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
3173 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
3174 consider the response complete.
3175
3176 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
3177 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
3178 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
3179 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
3180 "forceclose" option. That way the client gets a normal response and the
3181 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
3182
3183 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
3184 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
3185 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
3186 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
3187 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
3188 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
3189 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
3190
3191 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
3192 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Willy Tarreau22a95342010-09-29 14:31:41 +02003193 This option may be compbined with "option httpclose", which will cause
3194 keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to the
3195 client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003196
3197 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3198 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3199
3200 See also : "option forceclose" and "option http-server-close"
3201
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003202
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003203option http-server-close
3204no option http-server-close
3205 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
3206 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3207 yes | yes | yes | yes
3208 Arguments : none
3209
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003210 By default, when a client communicates with a server, HAProxy will only
3211 analyze, log, and process the first request of each connection. Setting
3212 "option http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the server
3213 side while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on
3214 the client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
3215 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save server
3216 resources, similarly to "option forceclose". It also permits non-keepalive
3217 capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients if they
3218 conform to the requirements of RFC2616. Please note that some servers do not
3219 always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close" in the
3220 request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A workaround
3221 consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003222
3223 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
3224 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
3225 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
3226 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01003227 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
3228 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003229
3230 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
3231 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003232 It is worth noting that "option forceclose" has precedence over "option
3233 http-server-close" and that combining "http-server-close" with "httpclose"
3234 basically achieve the same result as "forceclose".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003235
3236 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3237 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3238
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003239 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
3240 "option httpclose" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003241
3242
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01003243option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003244no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01003245 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
3246 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3247 yes | yes | yes | no
3248 Arguments : none
3249
3250 While RFC2616 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
3251 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
3252 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
3253 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
3254 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
3255 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
3256 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
3257
3258 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
3259 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
3260 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. The
3261 choice of header only affects requests passing through proxies making use of
3262 one of the "httpclose", "forceclose" and "http-server-close" options. Note
3263 that this option can only be specified in a frontend and will affect the
3264 request along its whole life.
3265
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01003266 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
3267 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
3268 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
3269 front of an existing proxy.
3270
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01003271 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
3272
3273 See also : "option httpclose", "option forceclose" and "option
3274 http-server-close".
3275
3276
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01003277option httpchk
3278option httpchk <uri>
3279option httpchk <method> <uri>
3280option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
3281 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
3282 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3283 yes | no | yes | yes
3284 Arguments :
3285 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
3286 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
3287 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
3288 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
3289 ones.
3290
3291 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
3292 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
3293 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
3294
3295 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
3296 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
3297 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
3298 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
3299 after "\r\n" following the version string.
3300
3301 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
3302 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
3303 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
3304 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
3305 the lack of any response.
3306
3307 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
3308
3309 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
3310 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
3311 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
3312
3313 Examples :
3314 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
3315 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
3316 backend https_relay
3317 mode tcp
3318 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
3319 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
3320
3321 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01003322 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
3323 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01003324
3325
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003326option httpclose
3327no option httpclose
3328 Enable or disable passive HTTP connection closing
3329 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3330 yes | yes | yes | yes
3331 Arguments : none
3332
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003333 By default, when a client communicates with a server, HAProxy will only
3334 analyze, log, and process the first request of each connection. If "option
3335 httpclose" is set, it will check if a "Connection: close" header is already
3336 set in each direction, and will add one if missing. Each end should react to
3337 this by actively closing the TCP connection after each transfer, thus
3338 resulting in a switch to the HTTP close mode. Any "Connection" header
3339 different from "close" will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003340
3341 It seldom happens that some servers incorrectly ignore this header and do not
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003342 close the connection eventhough they reply "Connection: close". For this
3343 reason, they are not compatible with older HTTP 1.0 browsers. If this happens
3344 it is possible to use the "option forceclose" which actively closes the
3345 request connection once the server responds. Option "forceclose" also
3346 releases the server connection earlier because it does not have to wait for
3347 the client to acknowledge it.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003348
3349 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
3350 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
3351 If "option forceclose" is specified too, it has precedence over "httpclose".
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003352 If "option http-server-close" is enabled at the same time as "httpclose", it
3353 basically achieves the same result as "option forceclose".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003354
3355 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3356 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3357
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003358 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close" and
3359 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003360
3361
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02003362option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003363 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
3364 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3365 yes | yes | yes | yes
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02003366 Arguments :
3367 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
3368 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
3369 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
3370 log analyser which only support the CLF format and which is not
3371 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003372
3373 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
3374 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
3375 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
3376 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
3377 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
3378 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
3379 ports.
3380
3381 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
3382
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02003383 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3384 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it. Specifying
3385 only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode if it was set
3386 by default.
3387
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003388 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003389
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003390
3391option http_proxy
3392no option http_proxy
3393 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
3394 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3395 yes | yes | yes | yes
3396 Arguments : none
3397
3398 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
3399 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
3400 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
3401 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
3402 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
3403
3404 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
3405 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
3406 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. Last,
3407 if the clients are susceptible of sending keep-alive requests, it will be
Cyril Bonté2409e682010-12-14 22:47:51 +01003408 needed to add "option httpclose" to ensure that all requests will correctly
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003409 be analyzed.
3410
3411 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3412 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3413
3414 Example :
3415 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
3416 backend direct_forward
3417 option httpclose
3418 option http_proxy
3419
3420 See also : "option httpclose"
3421
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02003422
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02003423option independant-streams
3424no option independant-streams
3425 Enable or disable independant timeout processing for both directions
3426 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3427 yes | yes | yes | yes
3428 Arguments : none
3429
3430 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
3431 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
3432 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
3433 receive data or not.
3434
3435 While this default behaviour is desirable for almost all applications, there
3436 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
3437 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
3438 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
3439 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
3440 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
3441 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
3442 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
3443 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
3444 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
3445 socket buffers.
3446
3447 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
3448 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
3449 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
3450 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
3451 slow lines, so use it with caution.
3452
3453 See also : "timeout client" and "timeout server"
3454
3455
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02003456option ldap-check
3457 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
3458 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3459 yes | no | yes | yes
3460 Arguments : none
3461
3462 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
3463 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
3464 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
3465 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
3466
3467 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
3468 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
3469
3470 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
3471 configure it.
3472
3473 Example :
3474 option ldap-check
3475
3476 See also : "option httpchk"
3477
3478
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02003479option log-health-checks
3480no option log-health-checks
3481 Enable or disable logging of health checks
3482 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3483 yes | no | yes | yes
3484 Arguments : none
3485
3486 Enable health checks logging so it possible to check for example what
3487 was happening before a server crash. Failed health check are logged if
3488 server is UP and succeeded health checks if server is DOWN, so the amount
3489 of additional information is limited.
3490
3491 If health check logging is enabled no health check status is printed
3492 when servers is set up UP/DOWN/ENABLED/DISABLED.
3493
3494 See also: "log" and section 8 about logging.
3495
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003496
3497option log-separate-errors
3498no option log-separate-errors
3499 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
3500 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3501 yes | yes | yes | no
3502 Arguments : none
3503
3504 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
3505 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
3506 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
3507 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
3508 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
3509 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
3510 provides very important information.
3511
3512 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
3513 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
3514 error logs.
3515
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003516 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003517 logging.
3518
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003519
3520option logasap
3521no option logasap
3522 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
3523 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3524 yes | yes | yes | no
3525 Arguments : none
3526
3527 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
3528 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
3529 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
3530 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
3531 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
3532 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
3533 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003534 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003535 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
3536 bytes are expected to be transferred.
3537
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003538 Examples :
3539 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
3540 mode http
3541 option httplog
3542 option logasap
3543 log 192.168.2.200 local3
3544
3545 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
3546 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
3547 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
3548 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
3549
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003550 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003551 logging.
3552
3553
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02003554option mysql-check [ user <username> ]
3555 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01003556 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3557 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02003558 Arguments :
3559 user <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting
3560 to MySQL server.
3561
3562 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
3563 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
3564 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialisation packet and/or
3565 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
3566 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
3567 in the MySQL table, like this :
3568
3569 USE mysql;
3570 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
3571 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
3572
3573 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
3574 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialisation packet or
3575 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
3576 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
3577 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
3578 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
3579 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
3580 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
3581 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
3582
3583 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
3584 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01003585
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02003586 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01003587
3588 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
3589 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
3590 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
3591 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
3592 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL server
3593 to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
3594
3595 See also: "option httpchk"
3596
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01003597option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
3598 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
3599 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3600 yes | no | yes | yes
3601 Arguments :
3602 user <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting
3603 to PostgreSQL server.
3604
3605 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
3606 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
3607 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
3608 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
3609
3610 See also: "option httpchk"
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01003611
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003612option nolinger
3613no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003614 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003615 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3616 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01003617 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003618
3619 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (eg: they are
3620 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
3621 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
3622 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
3623 connections.
3624
3625 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
3626 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
3627 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
3628 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
3629 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
3630 this too.
3631
3632 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
3633 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
3634 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
3635
3636 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
3637 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
3638 for servers.
3639
3640 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3641 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3642
3643
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003644option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
3645 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
3646 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3647 yes | yes | yes | yes
3648 Arguments :
3649 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
3650 matching <network>
3651 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
3652 header name.
3653
3654 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
3655 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
3656 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
3657 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
3658 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
3659 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
3660 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
3661 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
3662 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
3663 possible that the client has already brought one.
3664
3665 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
3666 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
3667 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
3668 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
3669 header and requires different one.
3670
3671 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
3672 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
3673 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
3674 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
3675 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
3676 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
3677 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
3678
3679 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
3680 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
3681 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
3682 both are defined.
3683
3684 It is important to note that as long as HAProxy does not support keep-alive
3685 connections, only the first request of a connection will receive the header.
3686 For this reason, it is important to ensure that "option httpclose" is set
3687 when using this option.
3688
3689 Examples :
3690 # Original Destination address
3691 frontend www
3692 mode http
3693 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
3694
3695 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
3696 backend www
3697 mode http
3698 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
3699
3700 See also : "option httpclose"
3701
3702
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003703option persist
3704no option persist
3705 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
3706 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3707 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01003708 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003709
3710 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
3711 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
3712 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
3713 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
3714 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
3715 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
3716 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
3717 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
3718 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
3719 redirected to another valid server.
3720
3721 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3722 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3723
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003724 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003725
3726
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003727option redispatch
3728no option redispatch
3729 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
3730 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3731 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01003732 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003733
3734 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
3735 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
3736 be able to access the service anymore.
3737
3738 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their
3739 persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
3740
3741 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
3742 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
3743 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003744
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003745 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
3746 "redisp" keywords.
3747
3748 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3749 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3750
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003751 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003752
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003753
3754option smtpchk
3755option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
3756 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
3757 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3758 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003759 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003760 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
3761 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESTMP). All other
3762 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
3763
3764 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
3765 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
3766 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
3767
3768 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
3769 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
3770 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
3771 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
3772 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
3773 dead server.
3774
3775 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
3776 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
3777 so you may want to experiment to improve the behaviour. Using telnet on port
3778 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
3779
3780 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
3781 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
3782 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
3783 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
3784 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in.
3785
3786 Example :
3787 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
3788
3789 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
3790
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003791
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02003792option socket-stats
3793no option socket-stats
3794
3795 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
3796 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3797 yes | yes | yes | no
3798
3799 Arguments : none
3800
3801
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01003802option splice-auto
3803no option splice-auto
3804 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
3805 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3806 yes | yes | yes | yes
3807 Arguments : none
3808
3809 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
3810 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
3811 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. Haproxy
3812 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003813 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01003814 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
3815 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
3816 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
3817 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
3818
3819 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
3820 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
3821 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
3822 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
3823 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
3824 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
3825 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
3826 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
3827 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
3828 keyword.
3829
3830 Example :
3831 option splice-auto
3832
3833 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3834 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3835
3836 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
3837 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
3838
3839
3840option splice-request
3841no option splice-request
3842 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
3843 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3844 yes | yes | yes | yes
3845 Arguments : none
3846
3847 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
3848 will user kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
3849 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
3850 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
3851 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
3852 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
3853
3854 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
3855
3856 Example :
3857 option splice-request
3858
3859 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3860 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3861
3862 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
3863 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
3864
3865
3866option splice-response
3867no option splice-response
3868 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
3869 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3870 yes | yes | yes | yes
3871 Arguments : none
3872
3873 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
3874 will user kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
3875 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
3876 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
3877 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
3878 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
3879
3880 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
3881
3882 Example :
3883 option splice-response
3884
3885 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3886 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3887
3888 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
3889 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
3890
3891
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003892option srvtcpka
3893no option srvtcpka
3894 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
3895 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3896 yes | no | yes | yes
3897 Arguments : none
3898
3899 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
3900 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
3901 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
3902 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
3903
3904 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
3905 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
3906 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
3907 operating system and its tuning parameters.
3908
3909 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
3910 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
3911 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
3912 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
3913 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
3914
3915 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
3916
3917 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
3918 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
3919 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
3920
3921 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3922 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3923
3924 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
3925
3926
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003927option ssl-hello-chk
3928 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
3929 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3930 yes | no | yes | yes
3931 Arguments : none
3932
3933 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
3934 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
3935 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
3936 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
3937 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
3938 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
3939 hello message.
3940
3941 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
3942 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
3943 messages, which is appreciable.
3944
3945 See also: "option httpchk"
3946
3947
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02003948option tcp-smart-accept
3949no option tcp-smart-accept
3950 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
3951 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3952 yes | yes | yes | no
3953 Arguments : none
3954
3955 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
3956 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
3957 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
3958 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
3959 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
3960 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
3961
3962 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
3963 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
3964 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
3965 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
3966
3967 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
3968 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
3969 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
3970 fall back to normal behaviour by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
3971
3972 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
3973 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
3974 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
3975
3976 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
3977 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
3978 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
3979
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02003980 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
3981
3982
3983option tcp-smart-connect
3984no option tcp-smart-connect
3985 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
3986 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3987 yes | no | yes | yes
3988 Arguments : none
3989
3990 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
3991 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
3992 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
3993 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
3994 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
3995
3996 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
3997 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
3998 complex.
3999
4000 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
4001 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
4002 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
4003
4004 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4005 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4006
4007 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
4008
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02004009
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004010option tcpka
4011 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
4012 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4013 yes | yes | yes | yes
4014 Arguments : none
4015
4016 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
4017 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
4018 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
4019 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
4020
4021 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
4022 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
4023 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
4024 operating system and its tuning parameters.
4025
4026 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
4027 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
4028 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
4029 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
4030 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
4031
4032 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
4033
4034 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
4035 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
4036 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
4037 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
4038 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
4039 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
4040 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
4041 backends.
4042
4043 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
4044
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004045
4046option tcplog
4047 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
4048 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4049 yes | yes | yes | yes
4050 Arguments : none
4051
4052 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
4053 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
4054 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
4055 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
4056 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
4057 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
4058 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
4059 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
4060
4061 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
4062
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004063 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004064
4065
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004066option transparent
4067no option transparent
4068 Enable client-side transparent proxying
4069 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01004070 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004071 Arguments : none
4072
4073 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
4074 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
4075 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
4076 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
4077 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
4078 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
4079 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
4080 appropriate server.
4081
4082 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
4083 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
4084
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01004085 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004086 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004087
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004088
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004089persist rdp-cookie
4090persist rdp-cookie(name)
4091 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
4092 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4093 yes | no | yes | yes
4094 Arguments :
4095 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02004096 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
4097 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004098
4099 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
4100 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
4101 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analysed
4102 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
4103 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
4104 forwarded to this server.
4105
4106 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
4107 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
4108 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004109 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004110 a single "listen" section.
4111
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02004112 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
4113 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
4114 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
4115
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004116 Example :
4117 listen tse-farm
4118 bind :3389
4119 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
4120 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
4121 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
4122 # apply RDP cookie persistence
4123 persist rdp-cookie
4124 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
4125 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
4126 balance rdp-cookie
4127 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
4128 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
4129
4130 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
4131
4132
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01004133rate-limit sessions <rate>
4134 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
4135 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4136 yes | yes | yes | no
4137 Arguments :
4138 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
4139 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
4140
4141 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
4142 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
4143 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
4144 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
4145 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
4146 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
4147
4148 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
4149 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
4150 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
4151 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
4152
4153 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
4154 listen smtp
4155 mode tcp
4156 bind :25
4157 rate-limit sessions 10
4158 server 127.0.0.1:1025
4159
4160 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status appears as
4161 "FULL" in the statistics, exactly as when it is saturated.
4162
4163 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
4164
4165
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01004166redirect location <to> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
4167redirect prefix <to> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004168 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
4169 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4170 no | yes | yes | yes
4171
4172 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01004173 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004174
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004175 Arguments :
4176 <to> With "redirect location", the exact value in <to> is placed into
4177 the HTTP "Location" header. In case of "redirect prefix", the
4178 "Location" header is built from the concatenation of <to> and the
4179 complete URI, including the query string, unless the "drop-query"
Willy Tarreaufe651a52008-11-19 21:15:17 +01004180 option is specified (see below). As a special case, if <to>
4181 equals exactly "/" in prefix mode, then nothing is inserted
4182 before the original URI. It allows one to redirect to the same
4183 URL.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004184
4185 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
4186 is desired. Only codes 301, 302 and 303 are supported, and 302 is
4187 used if no code is specified. 301 means "Moved permanently", and
4188 a browser may cache the Location. 302 means "Moved permanently"
4189 and means that the browser should not cache the redirection. 303
4190 is equivalent to 302 except that the browser will fetch the
4191 location with a GET method.
4192
4193 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
4194 expected behaviour of a redirection :
4195
4196 - "drop-query"
4197 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
4198 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
4199 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
4200 with a location-type redirect.
4201
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01004202 - "append-slash"
4203 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
4204 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
4205 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
4206 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
4207
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004208 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
4209 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
4210 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
4211 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
4212 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
4213 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
4214 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
4215
4216 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
4217 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
4218 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
4219 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
4220 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
4221 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
4222 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004223
4224 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
4225 acl clear dst_port 80
4226 acl secure dst_port 8080
4227 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004228 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01004229 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004230 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
4231
4232 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01004233 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
4234 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
4235 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004236 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004237
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01004238 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
4239 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
4240 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
4241
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004242 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004243
4244
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004245redisp (deprecated)
4246redispatch (deprecated)
4247 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
4248 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4249 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004250 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004251
4252 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
4253 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
4254 be able to access the service anymore.
4255
4256 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
4257 redistribute them to a working server.
4258
4259 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
4260 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
4261 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004262
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004263 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
4264 "option redispatch" instead.
4265
4266 See also : "option redispatch"
4267
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004268
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01004269reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004270 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
4271 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4272 no | yes | yes | yes
4273 Arguments :
4274 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4275 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004276 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004277
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01004278 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4279 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4280
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004281 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
4282 the last header of an HTTP request.
4283
4284 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4285 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4286 responses.
4287
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01004288 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
4289 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
4290 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
4291
4292 See also: "rspadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
4293 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004294
4295
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004296reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4297reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004298 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
4299 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4300 no | yes | yes | yes
4301 Arguments :
4302 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4303 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4304 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4305 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4306 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4307 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
4308 ignores case.
4309
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004310 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4311 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4312
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004313 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4314 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
4315 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
4316 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004317 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004318
4319 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4320 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
4321
4322 Example :
4323 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
4324 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
4325 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
4326
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004327 See also: "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and
4328 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004329
4330
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004331reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4332reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004333 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
4334 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4335 no | yes | yes | yes
4336 Arguments :
4337 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4338 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4339 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4340 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4341 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
4342 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
4343
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004344 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4345 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4346
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004347 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
4348 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
4349 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
4350 next servers.
4351
4352 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4353 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4354 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
4355
4356 Example :
4357 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
4358 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
4359 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
4360
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004361 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", section 6 about HTTP header
4362 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004363
4364
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004365reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4366reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004367 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
4368 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4369 no | yes | yes | yes
4370 Arguments :
4371 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4372 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4373 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4374 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4375 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4376 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
4377 case.
4378
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004379 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4380 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4381
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004382 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4383 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
4384 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
4385 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004386 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004387
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004388 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004389 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004390 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004391
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004392 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4393 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
4394
4395 Example :
4396 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
4397 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
4398 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
4399
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004400 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
4401 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004402
4403
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004404reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4405reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004406 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
4407 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4408 no | yes | yes | yes
4409 Arguments :
4410 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4411 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4412 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4413 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4414 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4415 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
4416 case.
4417
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004418 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4419 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4420
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004421 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4422 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
4423 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
4424 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
4425
4426 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4427 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
4428
4429 Example :
4430 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
4431 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
4432 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
4433 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
4434
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004435 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
4436 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004437
4438
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004439reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4440reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004441 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
4442 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4443 no | yes | yes | yes
4444 Arguments :
4445 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4446 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4447 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4448 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4449 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
4450 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
4451
4452 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4453 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
4454 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
4455 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004456 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004457
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004458 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4459 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4460
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004461 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
4462 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
4463 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
4464
4465 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4466 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4467 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
4468 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
4469 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
4470
4471 Example :
4472 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
4473 reqrep ^([^\ ]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
4474 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
4475 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
4476
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004477 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", section 6 about HTTP header
4478 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004479
4480
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004481reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4482reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004483 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
4484 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4485 no | yes | yes | yes
4486 Arguments :
4487 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4488 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4489 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4490 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4491 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4492 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
4493 ignores case.
4494
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004495 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4496 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4497
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004498 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4499 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004500 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
4501 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
4502 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004503 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
4504 not set.
4505
4506 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
4507 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
4508 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
4509 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
4510 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
4511
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004512 Examples :
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004513 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavour of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
4514 # block all others.
4515 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
4516 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
4517
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004518 # block bad guys
4519 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
4520 reqitarpit . if badguys
4521
4522 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", section 6 about HTTP header
4523 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004524
4525
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02004526retries <value>
4527 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
4528 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4529 yes | no | yes | yes
4530 Arguments :
4531 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
4532 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
4533 default value is 3.
4534
4535 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
4536 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
4537 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
4538
4539 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
4540 a turn-around timer of 1 second is applied before a retry occurs.
4541
4542 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
4543 server even if a cookie references a different server.
4544
4545 See also : "option redispatch"
4546
4547
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004548rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004549 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
4550 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4551 no | yes | yes | yes
4552 Arguments :
4553 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4554 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004555 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004556
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004557 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4558 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4559
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004560 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
4561 the last header of an HTTP response.
4562
4563 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4564 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4565 responses.
4566
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004567 See also: "reqadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
4568 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004569
4570
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004571rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4572rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004573 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
4574 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4575 no | yes | yes | yes
4576 Arguments :
4577 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4578 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
4579 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
4580 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
4581 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
4582 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
4583 ignores case.
4584
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004585 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4586 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4587
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004588 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
4589 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
4590 and/or sensible headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
4591 client.
4592
4593 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4594 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4595 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
4596
4597 Example :
4598 # remove the Server header from responses
4599 reqidel ^Server:.*
4600
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004601 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", section 6 about HTTP header
4602 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004603
4604
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004605rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4606rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004607 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
4608 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4609 no | yes | yes | yes
4610 Arguments :
4611 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4612 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
4613 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
4614 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
4615 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
4616 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
4617 ignores case.
4618
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004619 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4620 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4621
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004622 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4623 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
4624 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
4625 case-sensitive.
4626
4627 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004628 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
4629 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
4630 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004631
4632 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4633 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
4634
4635 Example :
4636 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
4637 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
4638
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004639 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation
4640 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004641
4642
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004643rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4644rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004645 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
4646 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4647 no | yes | yes | yes
4648 Arguments :
4649 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4650 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
4651 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
4652 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
4653 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
4654 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
4655 ignores case.
4656
4657 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4658 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
4659 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
4660 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004661 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004662
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004663 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4664 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4665
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004666 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
4667 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
4668 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
4669
4670 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4671 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4672 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
4673 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
4674 are not case-sensitive.
4675
4676 Example :
4677 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
4678 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
4679
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004680 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", section 6 about HTTP header
4681 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004682
4683
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01004684server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004685 Declare a server in a backend
4686 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4687 no | no | yes | yes
4688 Arguments :
4689 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
4690 appear in logs and alerts.
4691
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01004692 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
4693 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
4694 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
4695 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02004696 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
4697 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
4698 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
4699 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
4700 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
4701 to report statistics.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004702
4703 <ports> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
4704 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
4705 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
4706 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
4707 adding this value to the client's port.
4708
4709 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
4710 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004711 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004712
4713 Examples :
4714 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
4715 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
4716
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004717 See also: "default-server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004718
4719
4720source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02004721source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01004722source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004723 Set the source address for outgoing connections
4724 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4725 yes | no | yes | yes
4726 Arguments :
4727 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
4728 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
4729 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
4730 the most appropriate address to reach its destination.
4731
4732 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
4733 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02004734 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
4735 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
4736 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004737
4738 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
4739 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
4740 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
4741 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
4742 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
4743 <addr>.
4744
4745 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
4746 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
4747 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
4748 port.
4749
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02004750 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
4751 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
4752 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
4753 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
4754 and to automatically bind to the the client's IP address as seen
4755 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
4756 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
4757 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
4758 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
4759 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
4760 HTTP header.
4761
4762 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
4763 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
4764 in order to specificy which occurrence to use for the source IP
4765 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
4766 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
4767 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
4768 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
4769 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
4770 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
4771 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
4772
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01004773 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
4774 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
4775 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
4776 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
4777 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
4778 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
4779
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004780 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
4781 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
4782 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
4783 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
4784
4785 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
4786 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
4787 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
4788 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
4789 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
4790 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
4791
4792 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
4793 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
4794 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
4795 there are two methods :
4796
4797 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
4798 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
4799 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
4800 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
4801 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
4802 of the client ranges may be used.
4803
4804 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
4805 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
4806 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
4807 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
4808 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
4809 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
4810 same session.
4811
4812 Note that depending on the transparent proxy technology used, it may be
4813 required to force the source address. In fact, cttproxy version 2 requires an
4814 IP address in <addr> above, and does not support setting of "0.0.0.0" as the
4815 IP address because it creates NAT entries which much match the exact outgoing
4816 address. Tproxy version 4 and some other kernel patches which work in pure
4817 forwarding mode generally will not have this limitation.
4818
4819 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
4820 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
4821 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004822 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004823
4824 Examples :
4825 backend private
4826 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
4827 source 192.168.1.200
4828
4829 backend transparent_ssl1
4830 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
4831 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
4832
4833 backend transparent_ssl2
4834 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
4835 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
4836 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
4837
4838 backend transparent_ssl3
4839 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
4840 # is more conntrack-friendly.
4841 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
4842
4843 backend transparent_smtp
4844 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
4845 # with Tproxy version 4.
4846 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
4847
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02004848 backend transparent_http
4849 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
4850 # proxy.
4851 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
4852
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004853 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004854 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
4855
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004856
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004857srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
4858 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
4859 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4860 yes | no | yes | yes
4861 Arguments :
4862 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
4863 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
4864 as explained at the top of this document.
4865
4866 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
4867 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
4868 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
4869 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
4870 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
4871 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
4872 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
4873
4874 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
4875 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
4876 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
4877 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
4878 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004879 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004880 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004881 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004882
4883 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
4884 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
4885 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
4886 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
4887 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
4888 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
4889
4890 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
4891 Please use "timeout server" instead.
4892
4893 See also : "timeout server", "timeout client" and "clitimeout".
4894
4895
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02004896stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
4897 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
4898 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4899 no | no | yes | yes
4900
4901 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
4902 matched.
4903
4904 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
4905 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
4906
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01004907 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
4908 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
4909 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
4910
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01004911 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
4912 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
4913 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
4914 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02004915
4916 Example :
4917 # statistics admin level only for localhost
4918 backend stats_localhost
4919 stats enable
4920 stats admin if LOCALHOST
4921
4922 Example :
4923 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
4924 backend stats_auth
4925 stats enable
4926 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
4927 stats admin if TRUE
4928
4929 Example :
4930 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
4931 userlist stats-auth
4932 group admin users admin
4933 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
4934 group readonly users haproxy
4935 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
4936
4937 backend stats_auth
4938 stats enable
4939 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
4940 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
4941 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
4942 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
4943
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01004944 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
4945 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
4946 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02004947
4948
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004949stats auth <user>:<passwd>
4950 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
4951 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4952 yes | no | yes | yes
4953 Arguments :
4954 <user> is a user name to grant access to
4955
4956 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
4957
4958 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
4959 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
4960 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
4961 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
4962 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
4963 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
4964
4965 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
4966 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
4967 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
4968 that those ones should not be sensible and not shared with any other account.
4969
4970 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
4971 report using "stats scope".
4972
4973 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
4974 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
4975 unobvious parameters.
4976
4977 Example :
4978 # public access (limited to this backend only)
4979 backend public_www
4980 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
4981 stats enable
4982 stats hide-version
4983 stats scope .
4984 stats uri /admin?stats
4985 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
4986 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
4987 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
4988
4989 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
4990 backend private_monitoring
4991 stats enable
4992 stats uri /admin?stats
4993 stats refresh 5s
4994
4995 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
4996
4997
4998stats enable
4999 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
5000 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5001 yes | no | yes | yes
5002 Arguments : none
5003
5004 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
5005 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
5006 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
5007 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
5008 - stats auth : no authentication
5009 - stats scope : no restriction
5010
5011 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5012 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5013 unobvious parameters.
5014
5015 Example :
5016 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5017 backend public_www
5018 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5019 stats enable
5020 stats hide-version
5021 stats scope .
5022 stats uri /admin?stats
5023 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5024 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5025 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5026
5027 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5028 backend private_monitoring
5029 stats enable
5030 stats uri /admin?stats
5031 stats refresh 5s
5032
5033 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
5034
5035
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005036stats hide-version
5037 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005038 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5039 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005040 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005041
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005042 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
5043 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
5044 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
5045 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
5046 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
5047 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005048
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02005049 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5050 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5051 unobvious parameters.
5052
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005053 Example :
5054 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5055 backend public_www
5056 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02005057 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005058 stats hide-version
5059 stats scope .
5060 stats uri /admin?stats
5061 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5062 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5063 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005064
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005065 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5066 backend private_monitoring
5067 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005068 stats uri /admin?stats
5069 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01005070
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005071 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005072
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01005073
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02005074stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
5075 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5076 Access control for statistics
5077
5078 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5079 no | no | yes | yes
5080
5081 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
5082 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
5083 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
5084 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
5085 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
5086 should be asked to enter a username and password.
5087
5088 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
5089 instance.
5090
5091 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
5092 about ACL usage.
5093
5094
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005095stats realm <realm>
5096 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
5097 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5098 yes | no | yes | yes
5099 Arguments :
5100 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
5101 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
5102 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
5103
5104 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
5105 using a backslash ('\').
5106
5107 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
5108 only related to authentication.
5109
5110 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5111 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5112 unobvious parameters.
5113
5114 Example :
5115 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5116 backend public_www
5117 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5118 stats enable
5119 stats hide-version
5120 stats scope .
5121 stats uri /admin?stats
5122 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5123 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5124 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5125
5126 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5127 backend private_monitoring
5128 stats enable
5129 stats uri /admin?stats
5130 stats refresh 5s
5131
5132 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
5133
5134
5135stats refresh <delay>
5136 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
5137 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5138 yes | no | yes | yes
5139 Arguments :
5140 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
5141 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
5142 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
5143 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
5144 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
5145 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
5146
5147 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
5148 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
5149 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
5150 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
5151
5152 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5153 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5154 unobvious parameters.
5155
5156 Example :
5157 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5158 backend public_www
5159 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5160 stats enable
5161 stats hide-version
5162 stats scope .
5163 stats uri /admin?stats
5164 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5165 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5166 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5167
5168 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5169 backend private_monitoring
5170 stats enable
5171 stats uri /admin?stats
5172 stats refresh 5s
5173
5174 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
5175
5176
5177stats scope { <name> | "." }
5178 Enable statistics and limit access scope
5179 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5180 yes | no | yes | yes
5181 Arguments :
5182 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
5183 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
5184 section in which the statement appears.
5185
5186 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
5187 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
5188 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
5189 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
5190 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
5191 exists.
5192
5193 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5194 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5195 unobvious parameters.
5196
5197 Example :
5198 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5199 backend public_www
5200 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5201 stats enable
5202 stats hide-version
5203 stats scope .
5204 stats uri /admin?stats
5205 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5206 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5207 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5208
5209 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5210 backend private_monitoring
5211 stats enable
5212 stats uri /admin?stats
5213 stats refresh 5s
5214
5215 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
5216
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005217
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02005218stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005219 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
5220 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5221 yes | no | yes | yes
5222
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02005223 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005224 description from global section is automatically used instead.
5225
5226 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
5227 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
5228
5229 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5230 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5231 unobvious parameters.
5232
5233 Example :
5234 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5235 backend private_monitoring
5236 stats enable
5237 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
5238 stats uri /admin?stats
5239 stats refresh 5s
5240
5241 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
5242 global section.
5243
5244
5245stats show-legends
5246 Enable reporting additional informations on the statistics page :
5247 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
5248 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
5249 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
5250 - IP (socket, server)
5251 - cookie (backend, server)
5252
5253 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5254 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5255 unobvious parameters.
5256
5257 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
5258
5259
5260stats show-node [ <name> ]
5261 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
5262 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5263 yes | no | yes | yes
5264 Arguments:
5265 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
5266 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
5267
5268 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
5269 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
5270 provided for each customer.
5271
5272 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5273 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5274 unobvious parameters.
5275
5276 Example:
5277 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5278 backend private_monitoring
5279 stats enable
5280 stats show-node Europe-1
5281 stats uri /admin?stats
5282 stats refresh 5s
5283
5284 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
5285 section.
5286
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005287
5288stats uri <prefix>
5289 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
5290 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5291 yes | no | yes | yes
5292 Arguments :
5293 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
5294 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
5295 query string.
5296
5297 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
5298 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
5299 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
5300 possible to reach it in the application.
5301
5302 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005303 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005304 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
5305 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
5306 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
5307 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
5308
5309 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
5310 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
5311 an address or a port to statistics only.
5312
5313 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5314 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5315 unobvious parameters.
5316
5317 Example :
5318 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5319 backend public_www
5320 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5321 stats enable
5322 stats hide-version
5323 stats scope .
5324 stats uri /admin?stats
5325 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5326 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5327 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5328
5329 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5330 backend private_monitoring
5331 stats enable
5332 stats uri /admin?stats
5333 stats refresh 5s
5334
5335 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
5336
5337
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005338stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
5339 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005340 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005341 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005342
5343 Arguments :
5344 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.8. It
5345 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
5346 will be analysed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
5347 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
5348
5349 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
5350 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
5351 the "stick-table" statement.
5352
5353 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
5354 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
5355 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
5356 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
5357 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
5358
5359 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
5360 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
5361 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
5362 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
5363 transformation rules.
5364
5365 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
5366 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
5367 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
5368 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
5369 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
5370 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
5371 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
5372
5373 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
5374 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
5375 ACL based conditions.
5376
5377 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
5378 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
5379 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
5380 matches can be used as fallbacks.
5381
5382 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
5383 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
5384 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
5385 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
5386
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005387 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
5388 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
5389 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
5390
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005391 Example :
5392 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
5393 # last 30 minutes
5394 backend pop
5395 mode tcp
5396 balance roundrobin
5397 stick store-request src
5398 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
5399 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
5400 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
5401
5402 backend smtp
5403 mode tcp
5404 balance roundrobin
5405 stick match src table pop
5406 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
5407 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
5408
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005409 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
5410 about ACLs and pattern extraction.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005411
5412
5413stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
5414 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
5415 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5416 no | no | yes | yes
5417
5418 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
5419 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
5420 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
5421 for writing more maintainable configurations.
5422
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005423 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
5424 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
5425 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
5426
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005427 Examples :
5428 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01005429 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005430
5431 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
5432 stick match src table pop if !localhost
5433 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
5434
5435
5436 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
5437 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
5438 backend http
5439 mode http
5440 balance roundrobin
5441 stick on src table https
5442 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
5443 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
5444 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
5445
5446 backend https
5447 mode tcp
5448 balance roundrobin
5449 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
5450 stick on src
5451 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
5452 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
5453
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005454 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005455
5456
5457stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
5458 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
5459 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5460 no | no | yes | yes
5461
5462 Arguments :
5463 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.8. It
5464 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
5465 will be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
5466 server is selected.
5467
5468 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
5469 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
5470 the "stick-table" statement.
5471
5472 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
5473 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
5474 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
5475 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
5476 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
5477 address.
5478
5479 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
5480 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
5481 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
5482 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
5483 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
5484 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
5485 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
5486 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
5487 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
5488 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
5489
5490 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
5491 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
5492 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
5493 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
5494 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
5495 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
5496 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
5497
5498 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
5499 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
5500 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
5501 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
5502
5503 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
5504 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
5505 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
5506 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
5507 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
5508 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
5509 another protocol or access method.
5510
5511 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
5512 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
5513 the request.
5514
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005515 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
5516 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
5517 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
5518
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005519 Example :
5520 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
5521 # last 30 minutes
5522 backend pop
5523 mode tcp
5524 balance roundrobin
5525 stick store-request src
5526 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
5527 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
5528 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
5529
5530 backend smtp
5531 mode tcp
5532 balance roundrobin
5533 stick match src table pop
5534 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
5535 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
5536
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005537 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
5538 about ACLs and pattern extraction.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005539
5540
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02005541stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02005542 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
5543 [store <data_type>]*
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005544 Configure the stickiness table for the current backend
5545 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02005546 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005547
5548 Arguments :
5549 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
5550 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
5551 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
5552 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
5553
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01005554 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
5555 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
5556 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
5557 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
5558
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005559 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
5560 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
5561 instance.
5562
5563 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
5564 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
5565 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
5566 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
5567 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
5568 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02005569 to 32 characters.
5570
5571 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
5572 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
5573 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
5574 being stored. If the block provided by the pattern extractor
5575 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
5576 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005577
5578 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02005579 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
5580 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005581 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
5582 increase.
5583
5584 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01005585 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
5586 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
5587 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005588
5589 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
5590 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
5591 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
5592 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
5593 most often the desired behaviour. In some specific cases, it
5594 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
5595 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
5596 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
5597 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
5598 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
5599 parameter (see below).
5600
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02005601 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
5602 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
5603 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
5604 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
5605 soft restart.
5606
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005607 NOTE : peers can't be used in multi-process mode.
5608
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005609 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
5610 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
5611 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
5612 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
5613 section 2.2 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
5614 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
5615 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
5616 if not expiration delay is specified.
5617
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02005618 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
5619 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
5620 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
5621 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02005622 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
5623 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
5624 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
5625 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
5626 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
5627 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
5628 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
5629 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
5630 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
5631 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
5632 types and their arguments.
5633
5634 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
5635 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
5636 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
5637 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
5638
5639 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
5640 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
5641 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
5642 specific behaviour was detected and must be known for future matches.
5643
5644 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
5645 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
5646 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
5647 they were received.
5648
5649 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
5650 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
5651 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
5652 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
5653 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
5654
5655 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5656 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5657 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5658 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
5659 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
5660
5661 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
5662 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
5663 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
5664
5665 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5666 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5667 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5668 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
5669 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
5670
5671 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
5672 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
5673 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
5674 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
5675 the client side.
5676
5677 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5678 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5679 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5680 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
5681 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
5682 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
5683 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
5684
5685 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
5686 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
5687 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
5688 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
5689 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
5690 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
5691 (eg: vulnerability scan).
5692
5693 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5694 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5695 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5696 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
5697 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
5698 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
5699
5700 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
5701 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes received from clients
5702 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
5703 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
5704
5705 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5706 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5707 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5708 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
5709 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
5710 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
5711 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
5712 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
5713 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
5714 recommended for better fairness.
5715
5716 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
5717 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes sent to clients which
5718 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
5719 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
5720
5721 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
5722 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5723 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5724 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
5725 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
5726 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
5727 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
5728 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
5729 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
5730 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02005731
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02005732 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
5733 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005734 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
5735 reference it.
5736
5737 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
5738 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
5739 lost upon restart. In general it can be good as a complement but not always
5740 as an exclusive stickiness.
5741
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02005742 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
5743 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
5744 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
5745 something that can be ignored.
5746
5747 Example:
5748 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
5749 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
5750 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
5751 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
5752
5753 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.2
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01005754 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005755
5756
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02005757stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
5758 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
5759 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5760 no | no | yes | yes
5761
5762 Arguments :
5763 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.8. It
5764 describes what elements of the response or connection will
5765 be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
5766 server is selected.
5767
5768 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
5769 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
5770 the "stick-table" statement.
5771
5772 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
5773 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
5774 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
5775 when the response is a SSL server hello.
5776
5777 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
5778 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
5779 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
5780 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
5781 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
5782 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
5783 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
5784 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
5785 rules.
5786
5787 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
5788 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
5789 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
5790 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
5791 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
5792 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
5793 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
5794
5795 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
5796 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
5797 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
5798 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
5799
5800 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
5801 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
5802 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
5803 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
5804 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
5805 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
5806 another protocol or access method.
5807
5808 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
5809
5810 Example :
5811 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
5812 backend https
5813 mode tcp
5814 balance roundrobin
5815 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
5816 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
5817
5818 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
5819 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
5820
5821 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
5822 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
5823 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
5824
5825 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
5826 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
5827
5828 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
5829 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
5830 # at offset 44.
5831
5832 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
5833 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
5834
5835 # Learn on response if server hello.
5836 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
5837
5838 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
5839 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
5840
5841 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
5842 extraction.
5843
5844
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005845tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
5846 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02005847 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5848 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005849 Arguments :
5850 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
5851 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc1", "track-sc2".
5852 See below for more details.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02005853
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005854 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005855
5856 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
5857 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005858 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
5859 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
5860 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
5861 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
5862 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
5863 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005864
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005865 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
5866 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
5867 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
5868 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005869
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005870 Three types of actions are supported :
5871 - accept :
5872 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
5873 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
5874 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005875
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005876 - reject :
5877 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
5878 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
5879 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
5880 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
5881 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
5882 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
5883 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
5884 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
5885 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
5886 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
5887 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
5888 be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005889
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005890 - { track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
5891 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
5892 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. Two sets
5893 of counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The
5894 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
5895 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
5896 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
5897 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
5898 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005899
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005900 These actions take one or two arguments :
5901 <key> is mandatory, and defines the criterion the tracking key will
5902 be derived from. At the moment, only "src" is supported. With
5903 it, the key will be the connection's source IPv4 address.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005904
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005905 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
5906 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
5907 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
5908 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005909
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005910 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
5911 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
5912 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
5913 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
5914 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
5915 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
5916 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
5917 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
5918 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
5919 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005920
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005921 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
5922 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
5923 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005924
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005925 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
5926 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
5927 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005928
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005929 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005930 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005931 tcp-request connection track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005932
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005933 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
5934 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
5935 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005936
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005937 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
5938 tcp-request connection track-sc1 src
5939 tcp-request connection reject if { sc1_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005940
5941 See section 7 about ACL usage.
5942
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005943 See also : "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005944
5945
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005946tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
5947 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005948 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02005949 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005950 Arguments :
5951 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
5952 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc1", "track-sc2".
5953 See "tcp-request connection" above for their signification.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005954
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005955 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005956
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005957 A request's contents can be analysed at an early stage of request processing
5958 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
5959 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
5960 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
5961 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005962
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005963 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
5964 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
5965 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
5966 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
5967 both frontends and backends. In frontends, they will be evaluated upon new
5968 connections. In backends, they will be evaluated once a session is assigned
5969 a backend. This means that a single frontend connection may be evaluated
5970 several times by one or multiple backends when a session gets reassigned
5971 (for instance after a client-side HTTP keep-alive request).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005972
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005973 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
5974 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
5975 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
5976 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005977
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005978 Three types of actions are supported :
5979 - accept :
5980 - reject :
5981 - { track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005982
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005983 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
5984 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005985
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005986 Also, it is worth noting that if sticky counters are tracked from a rule
5987 defined in a backend, this tracking will automatically end when the session
5988 releases the backend. That allows per-backend counter tracking even in case
5989 of HTTP keep-alive requests when the backend changes. While there is nothing
5990 mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the track-sc1 pointer to track
5991 per-frontend counters and track-sc2 to track per-backend counters.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005992
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005993 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005994 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
5995 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005996
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005997 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
5998 rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full request has been
5999 buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this, the
6000 best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
6001 period.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006002
6003 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006004 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
6005 # and reject everything else.
6006 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
6007 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
6008 tcp-request content accept if HTTP is_host_com
6009 tcp-request content reject
6010
6011 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006012 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
6013 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
6014 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006015 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006016
6017 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
6018 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
6019 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006020 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006021 tcp-request content reject
6022
6023 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
6024 frontend when the backend detects abuse.
6025
6026 frontend http
6027 # Use General Purpose Couter 0 in SC1 as a global abuse counter
6028 # protecting all our sites
6029 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
6030 tcp-request connection track-sc1 src
6031 tcp-request connection reject if { sc1_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
6032 ...
6033 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
6034
6035 backend http_dynamic
6036 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
6037 # by SC2), block it globally in the frontend.
6038 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
6039 acl click_too_fast sc2_http_req_rate gt 10
6040 acl mark_as_abuser sc1_inc_gpc0
6041 tcp-request content track-sc2 src
6042 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006043
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006044 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006045
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006046 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request inspect-delay"
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006047
6048
6049tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
6050 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
6051 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02006052 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006053 Arguments :
6054 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6055 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6056 as explained at the top of this document.
6057
6058 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
6059 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
6060 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
6061 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
6062 data for at most the specified amount of time.
6063
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02006064 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
6065 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
6066 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
6067 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
6068
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006069 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
6070 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006071 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006072 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +01006073 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
6074 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
6075 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
6076 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006077
6078 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
6079 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
6080 it pass through unaffected.
6081
6082 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
6083 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
6084 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006085 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006086 before the server (eg: SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
6087 data to the server (eg: SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +02006088 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
6089 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
6090 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006091
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006092 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006093 "timeout client".
6094
6095
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02006096tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6097 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
6098 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6099 no | no | yes | yes
6100 Arguments :
6101 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
6102 actions include : "accept", "reject".
6103 See "tcp-request connection" above for their signification.
6104
6105 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
6106
6107 Response contents can be analysed at an early stage of response processing
6108 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
6109 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
6110 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection delay is
6111 set and expires with no matching rule.
6112
6113 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
6114
6115 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
6116 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
6117 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
6118 inserted.
6119
6120 Two types of actions are supported :
6121 - accept :
6122 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
6123 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
6124 the rules evaluation.
6125
6126 - reject :
6127 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
6128 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
6129 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediatly closed.
6130
6131 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
6132 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
6133 for changing the default action to a reject.
6134
6135 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-reponse content"
6136 rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has been
6137 buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this, the
6138 best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
6139 period.
6140
6141 See section 7 about ACL usage.
6142
6143 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
6144
6145
6146tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
6147 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
6148 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6149 no | no | yes | yes
6150 Arguments :
6151 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6152 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6153 as explained at the top of this document.
6154
6155 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
6156
6157
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006158timeout check <timeout>
6159 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
6160 established.
6161
6162 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6163 yes | no | yes | yes
6164 Arguments:
6165 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6166 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6167 as explained at the top of this document.
6168
6169 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
6170 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
6171 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (eg. those
6172 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +01006173 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
6174 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
6175 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006176
6177 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
6178 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
6179
6180 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
6181 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01006182 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006183
6184 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6185 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6186 forget about it.
6187
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01006188 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
6189 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006190
6191
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006192timeout client <timeout>
6193timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
6194 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
6195 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6196 yes | yes | yes | no
6197 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006198 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006199 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6200 as explained at the top of this document.
6201
6202 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
6203 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
6204 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
6205 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
6206 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
6207 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
6208 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
6209 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006210 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006211 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
6212 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds).
6213
6214 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
6215 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6216 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
6217 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
6218 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
6219 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
6220
6221 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
6222 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
6223 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
6224
6225 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server".
6226
6227
6228timeout connect <timeout>
6229timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
6230 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
6231 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6232 yes | no | yes | yes
6233 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006234 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006235 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6236 as explained at the top of this document.
6237
6238 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006239 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006240 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006241 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006242 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
6243 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006244
6245 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6246 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6247 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
6248 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
6249 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
6250 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
6251
6252 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
6253 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
6254 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
6255
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01006256 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
6257 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006258
6259
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006260timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
6261 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
6262 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6263 yes | yes | yes | yes
6264 Arguments :
6265 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6266 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6267 as explained at the top of this document.
6268
6269 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
6270 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
6271 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
6272 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
6273 once the request has started to present itself.
6274
6275 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
6276 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
6277 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
6278 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
6279 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
6280
6281 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
6282 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
6283 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
6284 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
6285
6286 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
6287 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
6288 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (eg:
6289 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
6290 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02006291 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006292
6293 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
6294 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
6295 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
6296 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
6297
6298 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
6299
6300
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006301timeout http-request <timeout>
6302 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
6303 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02006304 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006305 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006306 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006307 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6308 as explained at the top of this document.
6309
6310 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
6311 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
6312 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
6313 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
6314 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
6315 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
6316 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
6317 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time.
6318
6319 Note that this timeout only applies to the header part of the request, and
6320 not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is not
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006321 used anymore. It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
6322 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006323
6324 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
6325 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
6326 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (eg: 50 ms) will
6327 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
6328 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
6329
6330 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02006331 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
6332 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
6333 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006334
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006335 See also : "timeout http-keep-alive", "timeout client".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006336
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006337
6338timeout queue <timeout>
6339 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
6340 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6341 yes | no | yes | yes
6342 Arguments :
6343 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6344 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6345 as explained at the top of this document.
6346
6347 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
6348 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
6349 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
6350 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
6351 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
6352
6353 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
6354 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
6355 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
6356 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
6357
6358 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
6359
6360
6361timeout server <timeout>
6362timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
6363 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
6364 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6365 yes | no | yes | yes
6366 Arguments :
6367 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6368 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6369 as explained at the top of this document.
6370
6371 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
6372 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
6373 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
6374 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
6375 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
6376 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
6377 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
6378
6379 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
6380 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
6381 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
6382 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
6383 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006384 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006385 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006386 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006387
6388 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6389 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6390 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
6391 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
6392 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
6393 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
6394
6395 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
6396 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
6397 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
6398
6399 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client".
6400
6401
6402timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006403 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006404 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6405 yes | yes | yes | yes
6406 Arguments :
6407 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
6408 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6409 as explained at the top of this document.
6410
6411 When a connection is tarpitted using "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with
6412 no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit"
6413 defines how long it will be maintained open.
6414
6415 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
6416 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
6417 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
6418 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006419 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006420
6421 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
6422
6423
6424transparent (deprecated)
6425 Enable client-side transparent proxying
6426 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01006427 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006428 Arguments : none
6429
6430 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
6431 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
6432 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
6433 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
6434 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
6435 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
6436 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
6437 appropriate server.
6438
6439 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
6440
6441 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
6442 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
6443
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006444 See also: "option transparent"
6445
6446
6447use_backend <backend> if <condition>
6448use_backend <backend> unless <condition>
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02006449 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006450 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6451 no | yes | yes | no
6452 Arguments :
6453 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section.
6454
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006455 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006456
6457 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
6458 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
6459 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02006460 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
6461 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (eg:
6462 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
6463 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006464
6465 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
6466 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
6467 assign the backend.
6468
6469 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
6470 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
6471 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
6472 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
6473 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
6474 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
6475
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02006476 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006477 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02006478 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
6479 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
6480 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
6481
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02006482 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006483
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006484
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010064855. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01006486------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006487
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01006488The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
6489which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
6490arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
6491settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
6492after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
6493Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
6494address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006495
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006496 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01006497 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006498
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006499The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006500
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006501addr <ipv4>
6502 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
6503 to send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate an IP
6504 address to specific component able to perform complex tests which are more
6505 suitable to health-checks than the application. This parameter is ignored if
6506 the "check" parameter is not set. See also the "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006507
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006508 Supported in default-server: No
6509
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006510backup
6511 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
6512 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
6513 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
6514 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
6515 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "allbackups"
6516 option.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006517
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006518 Supported in default-server: No
6519
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006520check
6521 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
6522 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server will receive
6523 periodic health checks to ensure that it is really able to serve requests.
6524 The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the server,
6525 and the default source is the same as the one defined in the backend. It is
6526 possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the port using the
6527 "port" parameter, the source address using the "source" address, and the
6528 interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall" parameters. The
6529 request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk", "smtpchk",
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01006530 "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please refer to
6531 those options and parameters for more information.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006532
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006533 Supported in default-server: No
6534
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006535cookie <value>
6536 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
6537 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
6538 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
6539 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
6540 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
6541 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
6542 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
6543
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006544 Supported in default-server: No
6545
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +02006546disabled
6547 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
6548 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
6549 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
6550 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
6551 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
6552
6553 Supported in default-server: No
6554
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006555error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01006556 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
6557 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
6558 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006559
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006560 Supported in default-server: Yes
6561
6562 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006563
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006564fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006565 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
6566 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
6567 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
6568
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006569 Supported in default-server: Yes
6570
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006571id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02006572 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
6573 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
6574 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006575
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006576 Supported in default-server: No
6577
6578inter <delay>
6579fastinter <delay>
6580downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006581 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
6582 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
6583 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
6584 between checks depending on the server state :
6585
6586 Server state | Interval used
6587 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
6588 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
6589 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
6590 Transitionally UP (going down), |
6591 Transitionally DOWN (going up), | "fastinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
6592 or yet unchecked. |
6593 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
6594 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
6595 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006596
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006597 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
6598 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
6599 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
6600 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
6601 hosted on the same hardware, the health-checks of all servers are started
6602 with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to add some random
6603 noise in the health checks interval using the global "spread-checks"
6604 keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot of backends use the same
6605 servers.
6606
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006607 Supported in default-server: Yes
6608
6609maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006610 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
6611 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
6612 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
6613 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
6614 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
6615 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
6616 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
6617 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
6618
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006619 Supported in default-server: Yes
6620
6621maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006622 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
6623 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
6624 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
6625 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
6626 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
6627 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
6628 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
6629
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006630 Supported in default-server: Yes
6631
6632minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006633 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
6634 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
6635 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
6636 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
6637 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
6638 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006639 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006640 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006641
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006642 Supported in default-server: Yes
6643
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006644observe <mode>
6645 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
6646 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
6647 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
6648 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
6649 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
6650 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
6651 headers, a timeout, etc.
6652
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006653 Supported in default-server: No
6654
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006655 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
6656
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006657on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006658 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
6659 Currently, four modes are available:
6660 - fastinter: force fastinter
6661 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
6662 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
6663 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
6664 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
6665
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006666 Supported in default-server: Yes
6667
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006668 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
6669
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +09006670on-marked-down <action>
6671 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
6672 Currently one action is available:
6673 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions
6674
6675 Actions are disabled by default
6676
6677 Supported in default-server: Yes
6678
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006679port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006680 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
6681 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
6682 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
6683 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
6684 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
6685 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
6686
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006687 Supported in default-server: Yes
6688
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006689redir <prefix>
6690 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
6691 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
6692 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
6693 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
6694 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
6695 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
6696 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
6697 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006698 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006699 requests are still analysed, making this solution completely usable to direct
6700 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
6701 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
6702 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
6703 loop between the client and HAProxy!
6704
6705 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
6706
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006707 Supported in default-server: No
6708
6709rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006710 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
6711 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
6712 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
6713
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006714 Supported in default-server: Yes
6715
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +01006716send-proxy
6717 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
6718 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
6719 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
6720 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
6721 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" listener,
6722 the advertised address will be used. Only TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families
6723 are supported. Other families such as Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN
6724 family. Servers using this option can fully be chained to another instance of
6725 haproxy listening with an "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be
6726 used if the server isn't aware of the protocol. See also the "accept-proxy"
6727 option of the "bind" keyword.
6728
6729 Supported in default-server: No
6730
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006731slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006732 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
6733 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
6734 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
6735 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
6736 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
6737 parameters :
6738
6739 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
6740 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
6741
6742 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
6743 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
6744 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
6745 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
6746
6747 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
6748 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
6749 seen as failed.
6750
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006751 Supported in default-server: Yes
6752
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02006753source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02006754source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02006755source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006756 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
6757 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
6758 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
6759 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
6760
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02006761 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
6762 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
6763 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
6764 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
6765 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
6766 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
6767 server.
6768
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006769 Supported in default-server: No
6770
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006771track [<proxy>/]<server>
6772 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by
6773 tracking another one. Only a server with checks enabled can be tracked
6774 so it is not possible for example to track a server that tracks another
6775 one. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
6776 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
6777
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006778 Supported in default-server: No
6779
6780weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006781 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
6782 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
6783 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +02006784 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
6785 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
6786 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
6787 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
6788 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
6789 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006790
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006791 Supported in default-server: Yes
6792
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006793
67946. HTTP header manipulation
6795---------------------------
6796
6797In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
6798response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
6799request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
6800which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
6801against information leak from the internal network. But there is a limitation
6802to this : since HAProxy's HTTP engine does not support keep-alive, only headers
6803passed during the first request of a TCP session will be seen. All subsequent
6804headers will be considered data only and not analyzed. Furthermore, HAProxy
6805never touches data contents, it stops analysis at the end of headers.
6806
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +02006807There is an exception though. If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response"
6808(status code 1xx), it is able to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny,
6809rewrite or delete a header, but it will refuse to add a header to any such
6810messages as this is not HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers
6811in such responses is to stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006812happen, for instance because another downstream equipment would unconditionally
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +02006813add a header, or if a server name appears there. When such messages are seen,
6814normal processing still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
6815
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006816This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
6817in section 4.2 :
6818
6819 - reqadd <string>
6820 - reqallow <search>
6821 - reqiallow <search>
6822 - reqdel <search>
6823 - reqidel <search>
6824 - reqdeny <search>
6825 - reqideny <search>
6826 - reqpass <search>
6827 - reqipass <search>
6828 - reqrep <search> <replace>
6829 - reqirep <search> <replace>
6830 - reqtarpit <search>
6831 - reqitarpit <search>
6832 - rspadd <string>
6833 - rspdel <search>
6834 - rspidel <search>
6835 - rspdeny <search>
6836 - rspideny <search>
6837 - rsprep <search> <replace>
6838 - rspirep <search> <replace>
6839
6840With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
6841is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
6842parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
6843prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
6844Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
6845
6846 \t for a tab
6847 \r for a carriage return (CR)
6848 \n for a new line (LF)
6849 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
6850 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
6851 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
6852 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
6853 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
6854
6855The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
6856portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
6857above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
6858regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
68599 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
6860is very common to users of the "sed" program.
6861
6862The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
6863after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
6864
6865Notes related to these keywords :
6866---------------------------------
6867 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
6868 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
6869 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
6870
6871 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
6872 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
6873 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
6874
6875 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
6876 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
6877 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
6878 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
6879 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
6880
6881 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
6882 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
6883 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
6884 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
6885 useless headers before adding new ones.
6886
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006887 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006888 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
6889
6890 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
6891 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
6892 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
6893
6894 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
6895 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006896 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006897
6898
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010068997. Using ACLs and pattern extraction
6900------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006901
6902The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
6903content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
6904from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
6905simple :
6906
6907 - define test criteria with sets of values
6908 - perform actions only if a set of tests is valid
6909
6910The actions generally consist in blocking the request, or selecting a backend.
6911
6912In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
6913
6914 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
6915
6916This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
6917Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
6918and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
6919an operator which may be specified before the set of values. The values are
6920of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
6921
6922ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
6923'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
6924which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
6925
6926There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
6927performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
6928
6929The following ACL flags are currently supported :
6930
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02006931 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
6932 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006933 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
6934
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02006935The "-f" flag is special as it loads all of the lines it finds in the file
6936specified in argument and loads all of them before continuing. It is even
6937possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments if the patterns are to be loaded from
Willy Tarreau58215a02010-05-13 22:07:43 +02006938multiple files. Empty lines as well as lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will
6939be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs will be stripped. If it is absolutely
6940needed to insert a valid pattern beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a
6941space so that it is not taken for a comment. Depending on the data type and
6942match method, haproxy may load the lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast
6943lookups. This is true for IPv4 and exact string matching. In this case,
6944duplicates will automatically be removed. Also, note that the "-i" flag applies
6945to subsequent entries and not to entries loaded from files preceeding it. For
6946instance :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02006947
6948 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
6949
6950In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
6951the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
6952case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
6953too.
6954
6955Note that right now it is difficult for the ACL parsers to report errors, so if
6956a file is unreadable or unparsable, the most you'll get is a parse error in the
6957ACL. Thus, file-based ACLs should only be produced by reliable processes.
6958
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006959Supported types of values are :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006960
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006961 - integers or integer ranges
6962 - strings
6963 - regular expressions
6964 - IP addresses and networks
6965
6966
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020069677.1. Matching integers
6968----------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006969
6970Matching integers is special in that ranges and operators are permitted. Note
6971that integer matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value
6972expressed with a lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which
6973may be omitted.
6974
6975For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
6976unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
6977representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
6978
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006979As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
6980two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
6981instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
6982ranges and operators.
6983
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006984For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006985operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
6986Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
6987of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006988
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006989Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006990
6991 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
6992 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
6993 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
6994 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
6995 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
6996
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006997For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006998
6999 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
7000
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007001This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
7002
7003 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
7004
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007005
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020070067.2. Matching strings
7007---------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007008
7009String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
7010exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
7011characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
7012string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
7013to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007014before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007015
7016
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020070177.3. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
7018-------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007019
7020Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
7021they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
7022possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
7023passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
7024the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007025the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
7026match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007027
7028
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020070297.4. Matching IPv4 addresses
7030----------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007031
7032IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
7033netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
7034within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007035host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007036difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
7037at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
7038does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
7039parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007040
7041
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020070427.5. Available matching criteria
7043--------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007044
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020070457.5.1. Matching at Layer 4 and below
7046------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007047
7048A first set of criteria applies to information which does not require any
7049analysis of the request or response contents. Those generally include TCP/IP
7050addresses and ports, as well as internal values independant on the stream.
7051
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007052always_false
7053 This one never matches. All values and flags are ignored. It may be used as
7054 a temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
7055
7056always_true
7057 This one always matches. All values and flags are ignored. It may be used as
7058 a temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
7059
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007060avg_queue <integer>
Willy Tarreau6cbd6472010-09-08 19:06:18 +02007061avg_queue(backend) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007062 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
7063 divided by the number of active servers. This is very similar to "queue"
7064 except that the size of the farm is considered, in order to give a more
7065 accurate measurement of the time it may take for a new connection to be
7066 processed. The main usage is to return a sorry page to new users when it
7067 becomes certain they will get a degraded service. Note that in the event
7068 there would not be any active server anymore, we would consider twice the
7069 number of queued connections as the measured value. This is a fair estimate,
7070 as we expect one server to get back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send
7071 new traffic to another backend if in better shape. See also the "queue",
7072 "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +01007073
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007074be_conn <integer>
Willy Tarreau6cbd6472010-09-08 19:06:18 +02007075be_conn(backend) <integer>
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007076 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
7077 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
7078 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
7079 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
7080 See also the "fe_conn", "queue" and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007081
Hervé COMMOWICK35ed8012010-12-15 14:04:51 +01007082be_id <integer>
7083 Applies to the backend's id. Can be used in frontends to check from which
7084 backend it was called.
7085
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007086be_sess_rate <integer>
7087be_sess_rate(backend) <integer>
7088 Returns true when the sessions creation rate on the backend matches the
7089 specified values or ranges, in number of new sessions per second. This is
7090 used to switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one
7091 reaches too high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent
7092 sucking of an online dictionary).
7093
7094 Example :
7095 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
7096 backend dynamic
7097 mode http
7098 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
7099 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007100
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08007101connslots <integer>
7102connslots(backend) <integer>
7103 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007104 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08007105 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
7106
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007107 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
7108 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08007109
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007110 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007111 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
7112 multiple backends (perhaps using acls to do name-based load balancing) and
7113 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
7114 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
7115 actually *down*, this acl is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007116 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08007117
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007118 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
7119 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
7120 then this acl clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
7121 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08007122
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007123dst <ip_address>
7124 Applies to the local IPv4 address the client connected to. It can be used to
7125 switch to a different backend for some alternative addresses.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007126
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007127dst_conn <integer>
7128 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the same socket
7129 including the one being evaluated. It can be used to either return a sorry
7130 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
7131 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
7132 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
7133 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" criteria.
7134
7135dst_port <integer>
7136 Applies to the local port the client connected to. It can be used to switch
7137 to a different backend for some alternative ports.
7138
7139fe_conn <integer>
7140fe_conn(frontend) <integer>
7141 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
7142 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
7143 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
7144 frontend. It can be used to either return a sorry page before hard-blocking,
7145 or to use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is
7146 considered saturated. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn" and "fe_sess_rate"
7147 criteria.
7148
7149fe_id <integer>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01007150 Applies to the frontend's id. Can be used in backends to check from which
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007151 frontend it was called.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007152
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01007153fe_sess_rate <integer>
7154fe_sess_rate(frontend) <integer>
7155 Returns true when the session creation rate on the current or the named
7156 frontend matches the specified values or ranges, expressed in new sessions
7157 per second. This is used to limit the connection rate to acceptable ranges in
7158 order to prevent abuse of service at the earliest moment. This can be
7159 combined with layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for
7160 the rate to go down below the limit.
7161
7162 Example :
7163 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
7164 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
7165 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
7166 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
7167 frontend mail
7168 bind :25
7169 mode tcp
7170 maxconn 100
7171 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
7172 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
7173 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
7174 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007175
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007176nbsrv <integer>
7177nbsrv(backend) <integer>
7178 Returns true when the number of usable servers of either the current backend
7179 or the named backend matches the values or ranges specified. This is used to
7180 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
7181 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
7182 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01007183
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007184queue <integer>
Willy Tarreauf5a526f2010-09-01 08:06:18 +02007185queue(backend) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007186 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
7187 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
7188 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
7189 one. This can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level,
7190 generally indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers.
7191 One possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones.
7192 See also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
7193
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007194sc1_bytes_in_rate
7195sc2_bytes_in_rate
7196 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
7197 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
7198 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
7199
7200sc1_bytes_out_rate
7201sc2_bytes_out_rate
7202 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
7203 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
7204 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
7205
7206sc1_conn_cnt
7207sc2_conn_cnt
7208 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections from currently tracked
7209 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
7210
7211sc1_conn_cur
7212sc2_conn_cur
7213 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
7214 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
7215 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
7216
7217sc1_conn_rate
7218sc2_conn_rate
7219 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
7220 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
7221 See also src_conn_rate.
7222
7223sc1_get_gpc0
7224sc2_get_gpc0
7225 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
7226 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
7227
7228sc1_http_err_cnt
7229sc2_http_err_cnt
7230 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
7231 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
7232 See also src_http_err_cnt.
7233
7234sc1_http_err_rate
7235sc2_http_err_rate
7236 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
7237 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
7238 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
7239 src_http_err_rate.
7240
7241sc1_http_req_cnt
7242sc2_http_req_cnt
7243 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
7244 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
7245 src_http_req_cnt.
7246
7247sc1_http_req_rate
7248sc2_http_req_rate
7249 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
7250 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
7251 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
7252 src_http_req_rate.
7253
7254sc1_inc_gpc0
7255sc2_inc_gpc0
7256 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
7257 tracked counters, and returns its value. Before the first invocation, the
7258 stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
7259 return 1. The test can also be used alone and always returns true. This is
7260 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
7261 when a first ACL was verified :
7262
7263 acl abuse sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
7264 acl kill sc1_inc_gpc0
7265 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
7266
7267sc1_kbytes_in
7268sc2_kbytes_in
7269 Returns the amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
7270 counters, measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. The
7271 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
7272 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
7273
7274sc1_kbytes_out
7275sc2_kbytes_out
7276 Returns the amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
7277 counters, measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. The
7278 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
7279 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
7280
7281sc1_sess_cnt
7282sc2_sess_cnt
7283 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections that were transformed
7284 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
7285 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
7286 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
7287 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performend over the connection
7288 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
7289
7290sc1_sess_rate
7291sc2_sess_rate
7292 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
7293 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
7294 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
7295 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
7296 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
7297 performend over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
7298
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007299so_id <integer>
7300 Applies to the socket's id. Useful in frontends with many bind keywords.
7301
7302src <ip_address>
7303 Applies to the client's IPv4 address. It is usually used to limit access to
7304 certain resources such as statistics. Note that it is the TCP-level source
7305 address which is used, and not the address of a client behind a proxy.
7306
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007307src_bytes_in_rate <integer>
7308src_bytes_in_rate(table) <integer>
7309 Returns the average bytes rate from the connection's source IPv4 address in
7310 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
7311 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007312 not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007313
7314src_bytes_out_rate <integer>
7315src_bytes_out_rate(table) <integer>
7316 Returns the average bytes rate to the connection's source IPv4 address in the
7317 current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
7318 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007319 not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007320
7321src_conn_cnt <integer>
7322src_conn_cnt(table) <integer>
7323 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
7324 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
7325 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007326 See also sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007327
7328src_conn_cur <integer>
7329src_conn_cur(table) <integer>
7330 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
7331 current connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table
7332 or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007333 returned. See also sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007334
7335src_conn_rate <integer>
7336src_conn_rate(table) <integer>
7337 Returns the average connection rate from the connection's source IPv4 address
7338 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
7339 in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If the
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007340 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007341
7342src_get_gpc0 <integer>
7343src_get_gpc0(table) <integer>
7344 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
7345 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
7346 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007347 See also sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007348
7349src_http_err_cnt <integer>
7350src_http_err_cnt(table) <integer>
7351 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the current connection's
7352 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
7353 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007354 If the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007355
7356src_http_err_rate <integer>
7357src_http_err_rate(table) <integer>
7358 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the current connection's source
7359 IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
7360 table, measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table.
7361 This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007362 is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007363
7364src_http_req_cnt <integer>
7365src_http_req_cnt(table) <integer>
7366 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the current connection's
7367 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
7368 stick-table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007369 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007370
7371src_http_req_rate <integer>
7372src_http_req_rate(table) <integer>
7373 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the current connection's
7374 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
7375 stick-table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
7376 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007377 not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007378
7379src_inc_gpc0 <integer>
7380src_inc_gpc0(table) <integer>
7381 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the connection's
7382 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
7383 stick-table, and returns its value. If the address is not found, an entry is
7384 created and 1 is returned. The test can also be used alone and always returns
7385 true. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to
7386 mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
7387
7388 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
7389 acl kill src_inc_gpc0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007390 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007391
7392src_kbytes_in <integer>
7393src_kbytes_in(table) <integer>
7394 Returns the amount of data received from the connection's source IPv4 address
7395 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
7396 in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is not
7397 found, zero is returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007398 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007399
7400src_kbytes_out <integer>
7401src_kbytes_out(table) <integer>
7402 Returns the amount of data sent to the connection's source IPv4 address in
7403 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
7404 in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is not
7405 found, zero is returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007406 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02007407
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007408src_port <integer>
7409 Applies to the client's TCP source port. This has a very limited usage.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01007410
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007411src_sess_cnt <integer>
7412src_sess_cnt(table) <integer>
7413 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
7414 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
7415 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
7416 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007417 is returned. See also sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007418
7419src_sess_rate <integer>
7420src_sess_rate(table) <integer>
7421 Returns the average session rate from the connection's source IPv4 address in
7422 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
7423 amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A session is a
7424 connection that got past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007425 found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007426
7427src_updt_conn_cnt <integer>
7428src_updt_conn_cnt(table) <integer>
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02007429 Creates or updates the entry associated to the source IPv4 address in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007430 current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table. This table
7431 must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise the match
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02007432 will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the expiration
7433 timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match can't return
7434 zero. This is used to reject service abusers based on their source address.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007435 Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-counters" instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02007436
7437 Example :
7438 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
7439 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
7440 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
7441 listen ssh
7442 bind :22
7443 mode tcp
7444 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007445 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02007446 tcp-request content reject if { src_update_count gt 3 }
7447 server local 127.0.0.1:22
7448
Hervé COMMOWICK35ed8012010-12-15 14:04:51 +01007449srv_id <integer>
7450 Applies to the server's id. Can be used in frontends or backends.
7451
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +02007452srv_is_up(<server>)
7453srv_is_up(<backend>/<server>)
7454 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
7455 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
7456 looked up in the current backend. The function takes no arguments since it
7457 is used as a boolean. It is mainly used to take action based on an external
7458 status reported via a health check (eg: a geographical site's availability).
7459 Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in using dummy servers
7460 as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from the CLI, so that
7461 rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
7462
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +02007463table_avl <integer>
7464table_avl(table) <integer>
7465 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
7466 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
7467
7468table_cnt <integer>
7469table_cnt(table) <integer>
7470 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
7471 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
7472 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
7473
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007474
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020074757.5.2. Matching contents at Layer 4 (also called Layer 6)
7476---------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007477
7478A second set of criteria depends on data found in buffers, but which can change
7479during analysis. This requires that some data has been buffered, for instance
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007480through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request content"
7481keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007482
7483req_len <integer>
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02007484 Returns true when the length of the data in the request buffer matches the
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007485 specified range. It is important to understand that this test does not
7486 return false as long as the buffer is changing. This means that a check with
7487 equality to zero will almost always immediately match at the beginning of the
7488 session, while a test for more data will wait for that data to come in and
7489 return false only when haproxy is certain that no more data will come in.
7490 This test was designed to be used with TCP request content inspection.
7491
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +02007492req_proto_http
7493 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
7494 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007495 is used so there should be no surprises. This test can be used for instance
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +02007496 to direct HTTP traffic to a given port and HTTPS traffic to another one
7497 using TCP request content inspection rules.
7498
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02007499req_rdp_cookie <string>
7500req_rdp_cookie(name) <string>
7501 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like the RDP protocol, and
7502 a cookie is present and equal to <string>. By default, any cookie name is
7503 checked, but a specific cookie name can be specified in parenthesis. The
7504 parser only checks for the first cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol
7505 specification. The cookie name is case insensitive. This ACL can be useful
7506 with the "MSTS" cookie, as it can contain the user name of the client
7507 connecting to the server if properly configured on the client. This can be
7508 used to restrict access to certain servers to certain users.
7509
7510req_rdp_cookie_cnt <integer>
7511req_rdp_cookie_cnt(name) <integer>
7512 Returns true when the data in the request buffer look like the RDP protocol
7513 and the number of RDP cookies matches the specified range (typically zero or
7514 one). Optionally a specific cookie name can be checked. This is a simple way
7515 of detecting the RDP protocol, as clients generally send the MSTS or MSTSHASH
7516 cookies.
7517
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007518req_ssl_ver <decimal>
7519 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like SSL, with a protocol
7520 version matching the specified range. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
7521 messages are supported. The test tries to be strict enough to avoid being
7522 easily fooled. In particular, it waits for as many bytes as announced in the
7523 message header if this header looks valid (bound to the buffer size). Note
7524 that TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. This test was designed to be used
7525 with TCP request content inspection.
7526
Emeric Brun392d1d82010-09-24 15:45:16 +02007527req_ssl_hello_type <integer>
7528 Returns true when data in the request buffer looks like a complete SSL (v3
7529 or superior) hello message and handshake type is equal to <integer>.
7530 This test was designed to be used with TCP request content inspection: an
7531 SSL session ID may be fetched.
7532
7533rep_ssl_hello_type <integer>
7534 Returns true when data in the response buffer looks like a complete SSL (v3
7535 or superior) hello message and handshake type is equal to <integer>.
7536 This test was designed to be used with TCP response content inspection: a
7537 SSL session ID may be fetched.
7538
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +02007539wait_end
7540 Waits for the end of the analysis period to return true. This may be used in
7541 conjunction with content analysis to avoid returning a wrong verdict early.
7542 It may also be used to delay some actions, such as a delayed reject for some
7543 special addresses. Since it either stops the rules evaluation or immediately
7544 returns true, it is recommended to use this acl as the last one in a rule.
7545 Please note that the default ACL "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior
7546 declaration. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
7547 inspection.
7548
7549 Examples :
7550 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
7551 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
7552 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
7553
7554 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
7555 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
7556 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
7557 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
7558 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
7559 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
7560 tcp-request content reject
7561
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007562
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020075637.5.3. Matching at Layer 7
7564--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007565
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007566A third set of criteria applies to information which can be found at the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007567application layer (layer 7). Those require that a full HTTP request has been
7568read, and are only evaluated then. They may require slightly more CPU resources
7569than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and response are indexed.
7570
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007571hdr <string>
7572hdr(header) <string>
7573 Note: all the "hdr*" matching criteria either apply to all headers, or to a
7574 particular header whose name is passed between parenthesis and without any
7575 space. The header name is not case-sensitive. The header matching complies
7576 with RFC2616, and treats as separate headers all values delimited by commas.
7577 Use the shdr() variant for response headers sent by the server.
7578
7579 The "hdr" criteria returns true if any of the headers matching the criteria
7580 match any of the strings. This can be used to check exact for values. For
7581 instance, checking that "connection: close" is set :
7582
7583 hdr(Connection) -i close
7584
7585hdr_beg <string>
7586hdr_beg(header) <string>
7587 Returns true when one of the headers begins with one of the strings. See
7588 "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_beg() variant for
7589 response headers sent by the server.
7590
7591hdr_cnt <integer>
7592hdr_cnt(header) <integer>
7593 Returns true when the number of occurrence of the specified header matches
7594 the values or ranges specified. It is important to remember that one header
7595 line may count as several headers if it has several values. This is used to
7596 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
7597 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
7598 of certain headers. See "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use
7599 the shdr_cnt() variant for response headers sent by the server.
7600
7601hdr_dir <string>
7602hdr_dir(header) <string>
7603 Returns true when one of the headers contains one of the strings either
7604 isolated or delimited by slashes. This is used to perform filename or
7605 directory name matching, and may be used with Referer. See "hdr" for more
7606 information on header matching. Use the shdr_dir() variant for response
7607 headers sent by the server.
7608
7609hdr_dom <string>
7610hdr_dom(header) <string>
7611 Returns true when one of the headers contains one of the strings either
7612 isolated or delimited by dots. This is used to perform domain name matching,
7613 and may be used with the Host header. See "hdr" for more information on
7614 header matching. Use the shdr_dom() variant for response headers sent by the
7615 server.
7616
7617hdr_end <string>
7618hdr_end(header) <string>
7619 Returns true when one of the headers ends with one of the strings. See "hdr"
7620 for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_end() variant for
7621 response headers sent by the server.
7622
7623hdr_ip <ip_address>
7624hdr_ip(header) <ip_address>
7625 Returns true when one of the headers' values contains an IP address matching
7626 <ip_address>. This is mainly used with headers such as X-Forwarded-For or
7627 X-Client-IP. See "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use the
7628 shdr_ip() variant for response headers sent by the server.
7629
7630hdr_reg <regex>
7631hdr_reg(header) <regex>
7632 Returns true when one of the headers matches of the regular expressions. It
7633 can be used at any time, but it is important to remember that regex matching
7634 is slower than other methods. See also other "hdr_" criteria, as well as
7635 "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_reg() variant for
7636 response headers sent by the server.
7637
7638hdr_sub <string>
7639hdr_sub(header) <string>
7640 Returns true when one of the headers contains one of the strings. See "hdr"
7641 for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_sub() variant for
7642 response headers sent by the server.
7643
7644hdr_val <integer>
7645hdr_val(header) <integer>
7646 Returns true when one of the headers starts with a number which matches the
7647 values or ranges specified. This may be used to limit content-length to
7648 acceptable values for example. See "hdr" for more information on header
7649 matching. Use the shdr_val() variant for response headers sent by the server.
7650
7651http_auth(userlist)
7652http_auth_group(userlist) <group> [<group>]*
7653 Returns true when authentication data received from the client matches
7654 username & password stored on the userlist. It is also possible to
7655 use http_auth_group to check if the user is assigned to at least one
7656 of specified groups.
7657
7658 Currently only http basic auth is supported.
7659
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +02007660http_req_first
7661 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
7662 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
7663 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or even to perform
7664 some specific ACL checks only on the first request.
7665
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007666method <string>
7667 Applies to the method in the HTTP request, eg: "GET". Some predefined ACL
7668 already check for most common methods.
7669
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007670path <string>
7671 Returns true when the path part of the request, which starts at the first
7672 slash and ends before the question mark, equals one of the strings. It may be
7673 used to match known files, such as /favicon.ico.
7674
7675path_beg <string>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007676 Returns true when the path begins with one of the strings. This can be used
7677 to send certain directory names to alternative backends.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007678
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007679path_dir <string>
7680 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with
7681 slashes in the path. This is used to perform filename or directory name
7682 matching without the risk of wrong match due to colliding prefixes. See also
7683 "url_dir" and "path_sub".
7684
7685path_dom <string>
7686 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with dots
7687 in the path. This may be used to perform domain name matching in proxy
7688 requests. See also "path_sub" and "url_dom".
7689
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007690path_end <string>
7691 Returns true when the path ends with one of the strings. This may be used to
7692 control file name extension.
7693
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007694path_reg <regex>
7695 Returns true when the path matches one of the regular expressions. It can be
7696 used any time, but it is important to remember that regex matching is slower
7697 than other methods. See also "url_reg" and all "path_" criteria.
7698
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007699path_sub <string>
7700 Returns true when the path contains one of the strings. It can be used to
7701 detect particular patterns in paths, such as "../" for example. See also
7702 "path_dir".
7703
7704req_ver <string>
7705 Applies to the version string in the HTTP request, eg: "1.0". Some predefined
7706 ACL already check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
7707
7708status <integer>
7709 Applies to the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, eg: "302". It can be
7710 used to act on responses depending on status ranges, for instance, remove
7711 any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
7712
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007713url <string>
7714 Applies to the whole URL passed in the request. The only real use is to match
7715 "*", for which there already is a predefined ACL.
7716
7717url_beg <string>
7718 Returns true when the URL begins with one of the strings. This can be used to
7719 check whether a URL begins with a slash or with a protocol scheme.
7720
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007721url_dir <string>
7722 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with
7723 slashes in the URL. This is used to perform filename or directory name
7724 matching without the risk of wrong match due to colliding prefixes. See also
7725 "path_dir" and "url_sub".
7726
7727url_dom <string>
7728 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with dots
7729 in the URL. This is used to perform domain name matching without the risk of
7730 wrong match due to colliding prefixes. See also "url_sub".
7731
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007732url_end <string>
7733 Returns true when the URL ends with one of the strings. It has very limited
7734 use. "path_end" should be used instead for filename matching.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007735
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +01007736url_ip <ip_address>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007737 Applies to the IP address specified in the absolute URI in an HTTP request.
7738 It can be used to prevent access to certain resources such as local network.
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007739 It is useful with option "http_proxy".
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +01007740
7741url_port <integer>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007742 Applies to the port specified in the absolute URI in an HTTP request. It can
7743 be used to prevent access to certain resources. It is useful with option
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007744 "http_proxy". Note that if the port is not specified in the request, port 80
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007745 is assumed.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +01007746
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007747url_reg <regex>
7748 Returns true when the URL matches one of the regular expressions. It can be
7749 used any time, but it is important to remember that regex matching is slower
7750 than other methods. See also "path_reg" and all "url_" criteria.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01007751
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007752url_sub <string>
7753 Returns true when the URL contains one of the strings. It can be used to
7754 detect particular patterns in query strings for example. See also "path_sub".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01007755
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007756
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020077577.6. Pre-defined ACLs
7758---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007759
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007760Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
7761every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02007762order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007763
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007764ACL name Equivalent to Usage
7765---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007766FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +02007767HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007768HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
7769HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007770HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
7771HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
7772HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
7773HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
7774LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007775METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
7776METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
7777METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
7778METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
7779METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
7780METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02007781RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007782REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007783TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007784WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
7785---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007786
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007787
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020077887.7. Using ACLs to form conditions
7789----------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007790
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007791Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
7792combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007793
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007794 - AND (implicit)
7795 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
7796 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007797
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007798A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007799
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007800 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007801
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007802Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
7803indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007804
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007805For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
7806"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
7807requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
7808is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007809
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007810 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
7811 block if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
7812 block if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
7813 block unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007814
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007815To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
7816and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007817
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007818 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
7819 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
7820 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
7821 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007822
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007823 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static urls
7824 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
7825 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
7826 use_backend www if host_www
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007827
Willy Tarreau95fa4692010-02-01 13:05:50 +01007828It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
7829expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
7830be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
7831the braces must be seen as independant words). Example :
7832
7833 The following rule :
7834
7835 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
7836 block if METH_POST missing_cl
7837
7838 Can also be written that way :
7839
7840 block if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
7841
7842It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
7843to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
7844simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
7845sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
7846good use is the following :
7847
7848 With named ACLs :
7849
7850 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
7851 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
7852 monitor fail if site_dead
7853
7854 With anonymous ACLs :
7855
7856 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
7857
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007858See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "block" and "use_backend" keywords.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007859
Willy Tarreau5764b382007-11-30 17:46:49 +01007860
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010078617.8. Pattern extraction
7862-----------------------
7863
7864The stickiness features relies on pattern extraction in the request and
7865response. Sometimes the data needs to be converted first before being stored,
7866for instance converted from ASCII to IP or upper case to lower case.
7867
7868All these operations of data extraction and conversion are defined as
7869"pattern extraction rules". A pattern rule always has the same format. It
7870begins with a single pattern fetch word, potentially followed by a list of
7871arguments within parenthesis then an optional list of transformations. As
7872much as possible, the pattern fetch functions use the same name as their
7873equivalent used in ACLs.
7874
7875The list of currently supported pattern fetch functions is the following :
7876
7877 src This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session.
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01007878 It is of type IPv4 and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
7879 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent,
7880 according to RFC 4291.
7881
7882 src6 This is the source IPv6 address of the client of the session.
7883 It is of type IPv6 and only works with such tables.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007884
7885 dst This is the destination IPv4 address of the session on the
7886 client side, which is the address the client connected to.
7887 It can be useful when running in transparent mode. It is of
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01007888 type IPv4 and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
7889 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent,
7890 according to RFC 4291.
7891
7892 dst6 This is the destination IPv6 address of the session on the
7893 client side, which is the address the client connected to.
7894 It can be useful when running in transparent mode. It is of
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +09007895 type IPv6 and only works with such tables.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007896
7897 dst_port This is the destination TCP port of the session on the client
7898 side, which is the port the client connected to. This might be
7899 used when running in transparent mode or when assigning dynamic
7900 ports to some clients for a whole application session. It is of
7901 type integer and only works with such tables.
7902
Willy Tarreau4a568972010-05-12 08:08:50 +02007903 hdr(name) This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP
7904 request and converts it to an IP address. This IP address is
7905 then used to match the table. A typical use is with the
7906 x-forwarded-for header.
7907
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007908 payload(offset,length)
7909 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes, and starting
7910 at bytes <offset> in the buffer of request or response (request
7911 on "stick on" or "stick match" or response in on "stick store
7912 response").
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007913
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007914 payload_lv(offset1,length[,offset2])
7915 This extracts a binary block. In a first step the size of the
7916 block is read from response or request buffer at <offset>
7917 bytes and considered coded on <length> bytes. In a second step
7918 data of the block are read from buffer at <offset2> bytes
7919 (by default <lengthoffset> + <lengthsize>).
7920 If <offset2> is prefixed by '+' or '-', it is relative to
7921 <lengthoffset> + <lengthsize> else it is absolute.
7922 Ex: see SSL session id example in "stick table" chapter.
7923
David Cournapeau16023ee2010-12-23 20:55:41 +09007924 url_param(name)
7925 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +09007926 the query string of the request and uses the corresponding value
David Cournapeau16023ee2010-12-23 20:55:41 +09007927 to match. A typical use is to get sticky session through url (e.g.
7928 http://example.com/foo?JESSIONID=some_id with
7929 url_param(JSESSIONID)), for cases where cookies cannot be used.
7930
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007931The currently available list of transformations include :
7932
7933 lower Convert a string pattern to lower case. This can only be placed
7934 after a string pattern fetch function or after a conversion
7935 function returning a string type. The result is of type string.
7936
7937 upper Convert a string pattern to upper case. This can only be placed
7938 after a string pattern fetch function or after a conversion
7939 function returning a string type. The result is of type string.
7940
Willy Tarreaud31d6eb2010-01-26 18:01:41 +01007941 ipmask(mask) Apply a mask to an IPv4 address, and use the result for lookups
7942 and storage. This can be used to make all hosts within a
7943 certain mask to share the same table entries and as such use
7944 the same server. The mask can be passed in dotted form (eg:
7945 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (eg: 24).
7946
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007947
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020079488. Logging
7949----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007950
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007951One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
7952provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
7953very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
7954provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
7955state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007956to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007957headers.
7958
7959In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
7960about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
7961send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
7962
7963 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
7964 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
7965 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
7966 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
7967 at the termination.
7968
7969The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
7970allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
7971as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
7972while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
7973real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
7974delay.
7975
7976
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020079778.1. Log levels
7978---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007979
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +09007980TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007981source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +09007982HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
7983in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
7984track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
7985syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
7986about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007987
7988
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020079898.2. Log formats
7990----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007991
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02007992HAProxy supports 4 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +09007993and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
7994slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
7995options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007996
7997 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
7998 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
7999 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
8000 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
8001 extents.
8002
8003 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
8004 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
8005 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
8006 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
8007 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
8008
8009 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
8010 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
8011 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
8012 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
8013 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
8014
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008015 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
8016 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
8017 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
8018 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
8019
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008020Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
8021specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
8022field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
8023servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
8024always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
8025identifier.
8026
8027Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
8028 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
8029 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
8030 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
8031 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
8032
8033
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020080348.2.1. Default log format
8035-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008036
8037This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
8038as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
8039format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
8040
8041 Example :
8042 listen www
8043 mode http
8044 log global
8045 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
8046
8047 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
8048 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
8049 (www/HTTP)
8050
8051 Field Format Extract from the example above
8052 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
8053 2 'Connect from' Connect from
8054 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
8055 4 'to' to
8056 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
8057 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
8058
8059Detailed fields description :
8060 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
8061 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
8062 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
8063 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
8064 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
8065 and processed the connection.
8066 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
8067
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01008068In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
8069"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
8070connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
8071
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008072It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
8073will eventually disappear.
8074
8075
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020080768.2.2. TCP log format
8077---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008078
8079The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
8080is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
8081information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
8082counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
8083emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
8084environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
8085the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
8086sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008087specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
8088not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
8089fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
8090marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008091
8092 Example :
8093 frontend fnt
8094 mode tcp
8095 option tcplog
8096 log global
8097 default_backend bck
8098
8099 backend bck
8100 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
8101
8102 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
8103 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
8104 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
8105
8106 Field Format Extract from the example above
8107 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
8108 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
8109 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
8110 4 frontend_name fnt
8111 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
8112 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
8113 7 bytes_read* 212
8114 8 termination_state --
8115 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
8116 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
8117
8118Detailed fields description :
8119 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01008120 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
8121 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
8122 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
8123 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
8124 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008125
8126 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01008127 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
8128 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
8129 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008130
8131 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
8132 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
8133 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
8134 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log.
8135
8136 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
8137 and processed the connection.
8138
8139 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
8140 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
8141 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
8142 applications.
8143
8144 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
8145 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
8146 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
8147 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
8148 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
8149
8150 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
8151 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
8152 See "Timers" below for more details.
8153
8154 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
8155 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
8156 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
8157 "Timers" below for more details.
8158
8159 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
8160 last close. It covers all possible processings. There is one exception, if
8161 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
8162 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
8163 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
8164 details.
8165
8166 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
8167 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
8168 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
8169 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
8170 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
8171
8172 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
8173 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
8174 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
8175 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
8176 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
8177 for more details.
8178
8179 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
8180 the session was logged. It it useful to detect when some per-process system
8181 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
8182 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
8183 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008184 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008185
8186 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
8187 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
8188 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
8189 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
8190 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
8191 caused by a denial of service attack.
8192
8193 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
8194 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
8195 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
8196 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
8197 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
8198 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
8199 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
8200 denial of service attack.
8201
8202 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
8203 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
8204 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
8205 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
8206 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
8207 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
8208 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
8209 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
8210 be processed than on other servers.
8211
8212 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
8213 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
8214 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
8215 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
8216 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
8217 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
8218 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
8219 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
8220 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
8221 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
8222 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
8223 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
8224 should not be attributed to the logged server.
8225
8226 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
8227 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
8228 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
8229 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
8230 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
8231 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
8232 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
8233 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
8234
8235 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
8236 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
8237 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
8238 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
8239 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
8240 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
8241 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
8242 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
8243 occurs.
8244
8245
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020082468.2.3. HTTP log format
8247----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008248
8249The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
8250is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
8251the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
8252are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
8253emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
8254generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
8255"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
8256which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008257frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
8258is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008259
8260Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
8261slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
8262with a star ('*') after the field name below.
8263
8264 Example :
8265 frontend http-in
8266 mode http
8267 option httplog
8268 log global
8269 default_backend bck
8270
8271 backend static
8272 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
8273
8274 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
8275 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
8276 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008277 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008278
8279 Field Format Extract from the example above
8280 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
8281 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
8282 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
8283 4 frontend_name http-in
8284 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
8285 6 Tq '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Tt* 10/0/30/69/109
8286 7 status_code 200
8287 8 bytes_read* 2750
8288 9 captured_request_cookie -
8289 10 captured_response_cookie -
8290 11 termination_state ----
8291 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
8292 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
8293 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
8294 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
8295 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008296
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008297
8298Detailed fields description :
8299 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01008300 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
8301 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
8302 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
8303 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
8304 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008305
8306 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01008307 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
8308 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
8309 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008310
8311 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the TCP connection was received by
8312 haproxy (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on
8313 the network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is
8314 usually the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. This
8315 does not depend on the fact that the client has sent the request or not.
8316
8317 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
8318 and processed the connection.
8319
8320 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
8321 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
8322 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
8323
8324 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
8325 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
8326 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
8327 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
8328 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
8329 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
8330
8331 - "Tq" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the client to send
8332 a full HTTP request, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the connection
8333 was aborted before a complete request could be received. It should always
8334 be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet. Large
8335 times here generally indicate network trouble between the client and
8336 haproxy. See "Timers" below for more details.
8337
8338 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
8339 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
8340 See "Timers" below for more details.
8341
8342 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
8343 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
8344 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See "Timers"
8345 below for more details.
8346
8347 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
8348 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
8349 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
8350 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
8351 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
8352 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See "Timers" below
8353 for more details.
8354
8355 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
8356 last close. It covers all possible processings. There is one exception, if
8357 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
8358 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
8359 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
8360 details.
8361
8362 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
8363 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
8364 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
8365
8366 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
8367 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
8368 specified, the this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
8369 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
8370 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
8371 overflowing.
8372
8373 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
8374 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
8375 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
8376 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
8377 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
8378 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
8379 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
8380 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
8381
8382 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
8383 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
8384 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
8385 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
8386 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
8387 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
8388 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
8389 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
8390
8391 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
8392 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
8393 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
8394 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
8395 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
8396 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
8397 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
8398
8399 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
8400 the session was logged. It it useful to detect when some per-process system
8401 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
8402 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
8403 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008404 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008405 system.
8406
8407 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
8408 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
8409 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
8410 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
8411 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
8412 caused by a denial of service attack.
8413
8414 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
8415 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
8416 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
8417 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
8418 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
8419 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
8420 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
8421 denial of service attack.
8422
8423 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
8424 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
8425 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
8426 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
8427 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
8428 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
8429 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
8430 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
8431 processed than on other servers.
8432
8433 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
8434 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
8435 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
8436 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
8437 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
8438 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
8439 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
8440 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
8441 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
8442 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
8443 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
8444 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
8445 should not be attributed to the logged server.
8446
8447 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
8448 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
8449 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
8450 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
8451 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
8452 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
8453 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
8454 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
8455
8456 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
8457 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
8458 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
8459 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
8460 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
8461 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
8462 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
8463 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
8464 occurs.
8465
8466 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
8467 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
8468 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
8469 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
8470 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
8471 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
8472 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
8473 cookies" below for more details.
8474
8475 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
8476 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
8477 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
8478 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
8479 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
8480 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
8481 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
8482 and cookies" below for more details.
8483
8484 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
8485 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
8486 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
8487 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
8488 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
8489 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
8490 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
8491 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
8492
8493
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020084948.3. Advanced logging options
8495-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008496
8497Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
8498just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
8499options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
8500for more information about their usage.
8501
8502
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020085038.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
8504------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008505
8506It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
8507haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
8508commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
8509monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
8510ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
8511
8512 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
8513 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
8514 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
8515 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
8516
8517 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
8518 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
8519 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
8520 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipments
8521 such as other load-balancers.
8522
8523 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
8524 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
8525 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
8526
8527
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020085288.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
8529----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008530
8531The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
8532what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
8533or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
8534"option logasap" in the frontend. Haproxy will then log as soon as possible,
8535just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
8536log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
8537after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
8538is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
8539with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
8540with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
8541
8542
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020085438.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
8544------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008545
8546Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
8547for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
8548"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
8549retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
8550raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
8551a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
8552file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
8553you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
8554"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
8555
8556
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020085578.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
8558--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008559
8560Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
8561multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
8562them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
8563"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
8564logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
8565error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
8566and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
8567too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
8568useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
8569alternative.
8570
8571
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020085728.4. Timing events
8573------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008574
8575Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
8576reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
8577the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
8578frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
8579mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/Tt" :
8580
8581 - Tq: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
8582 elapsed between the moment the client connection was accepted and the
8583 moment the proxy received the last HTTP header. The value "-1" indicates
8584 that the end of headers (empty line) has never been seen. This happens when
8585 the client closes prematurely or times out.
8586
8587 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
8588 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
8589 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
8590 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
8591 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
8592
8593 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
8594 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
8595 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
8596 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
8597 connection never established.
8598
8599 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
8600 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
8601 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
8602 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
8603 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
8604 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
8605 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
8606 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
8607 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
8608 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
8609 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
8610
8611 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
8612 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
8613 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Tq+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
8614 prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
8615 transmission time, by substracting other timers when valid :
8616
8617 Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr)
8618
8619 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
8620 mode, "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never be
8621 negative.
8622
8623These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
8624protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
8625that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008626due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Tt" is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008627close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means that a
8628session has been aborted on timeout.
8629
8630Most common cases :
8631
8632 - If "Tq" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
8633 client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might happen
8634 when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It may
8635 happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network cause.
8636 Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has ended,
8637 haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds. The time
8638 spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay processing
8639 of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the order of
8640 a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of new
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +02008641 connections have been accepted at once. Setting "option http-server-close"
8642 may display larger request times since "Tq" also measures the time spent
8643 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008644
8645 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
8646 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
8647 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
8648 of ms on remote networks.
8649
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008650 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
8651 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
8652 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008653
8654 - If "Tt" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
8655 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection, for
8656 instance because both have agreed on a keep-alive connection mode. In order
8657 to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify "option httpclose" on
8658 either the frontend or the backend. If the problem persists, it means that
8659 the server ignores the "close" connection mode and expects the client to
8660 close. Then it will be required to use "option forceclose". Having the
8661 smallest possible 'Tt' is important when connection regulation is used with
8662 the "maxconn" option on the servers, since no new connection will be sent
8663 to the server until another one is released.
8664
8665Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
8666
8667 Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Tt The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
8668 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
8669 except "Tt" which is shorter than reality.
8670
8671 -1/xx/xx/xx/Tt The client was not able to send a complete request in time
8672 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
8673 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
8674
8675 Tq/-1/xx/xx/Tt It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
8676 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
8677 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
8678 flags.
8679
8680 Tq/Tw/-1/xx/Tt The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
8681 actively refused it or it timed out after Tt-(Tq+Tw) ms.
8682 Check the session termination flags, then check the
8683 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
8684 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
8685 the client connection was maintained open.
8686
8687 Tq/Tw/Tc/-1/Tt The server has accepted the connection but did not return
8688 a complete response in time, or it closed its connexion
8689 unexpectedly after Tt-(Tq+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
8690 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
8691
8692
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020086938.5. Session state at disconnection
8694-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008695
8696TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
8697"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
86982-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
8699each of which has a special meaning :
8700
8701 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
8702 session to terminate :
8703
8704 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
8705
8706 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
8707 server explicitly refused it.
8708
8709 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
8710 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
8711 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
8712 error in server response which might have caused information leak
8713 (eg: cacheable cookie), or because the response was processed by
8714 the proxy (redirect, stats, etc...).
8715
8716 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
8717 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
8718 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
8719 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
8720 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
8721
8722 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
8723 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
8724 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
8725 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
8726 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
8727
8728 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
8729 send or receive data.
8730
8731 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
8732 send or receive data.
8733
8734 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
8735 with nothing left in the buffers.
8736
8737 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
8738
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01008739 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008740 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
8741
8742 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
8743 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
8744 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
8745 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
8746 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
8747
8748 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
8749 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
8750
8751 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
8752 server (HTTP only).
8753
8754 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
8755
8756 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
8757 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
8758 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
8759
8760 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
8761 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
8762 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
8763
8764 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
8765
8766 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
8767 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
8768
8769 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
8770 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
8771 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
8772
8773 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
8774 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02008775 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
8776 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008777
8778 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
8779 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
8780 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
8781 another server.
8782
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02008783 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008784 server.
8785
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02008786 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
8787 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
8788 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
8789 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
8790
8791 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
8792 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
8793 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
8794 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
8795
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008796 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
8797
8798 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
8799 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
8800
8801 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
8802
8803 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
8804 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
8805 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
8806
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02008807 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
8808 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
8809 happens everytime there is activity at a different date than the
8810 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
8811 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
8812
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008813 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
8814
8815 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
8816 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
8817
8818 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
8819
8820 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
8821
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02008822The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
8823was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008824helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
8825starvation, attacks, etc...
8826
8827The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
8828alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
8829easier finding and understanding.
8830
8831 Flags Reason
8832
8833 -- Normal termination.
8834
8835 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
8836 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
8837 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
8838 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
8839
8840 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
8841 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
8842 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
8843 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
8844 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
8845 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008846
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008847 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
8848 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
8849 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
8850
8851 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
8852 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
8853 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
8854
8855 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
8856 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
8857 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
8858 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
8859 the server takes too long to respond.
8860
8861 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
8862 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
8863 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
8864 long a time to respond.
8865
8866 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
8867 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
8868 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
8869 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
8870 and the client.
8871
8872 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
8873 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
8874 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
8875 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
8876 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
8877 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here.
8878
8879 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
8880 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008881 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
8882 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
8883 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
8884 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008885
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008886 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008887 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
8888 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
8889 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (eg: no route,
8890 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
8891 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
8892
8893 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
8894 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
8895 503 or 504 here.
8896
8897 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
8898 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
8899 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
8900 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
8901 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
8902
8903 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
8904 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008905 by too short timeouts on L4 equipments before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008906 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
8907 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
8908
8909 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
8910 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
8911 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
8912 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
8913 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
8914 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
8915 between haproxy and the server.
8916
8917 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
8918 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
8919 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
8920 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
8921 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
8922 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
8923 solution is to fix the application.
8924
8925 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
8926 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
8927 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
8928 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
8929 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
8930 external attacks.
8931
8932 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
8933 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
8934 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
8935 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
8936 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
8937
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +01008938 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
8939 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
8940 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
8941 the client.
8942
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008943 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
8944 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
8945 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
8946 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +01008947 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
8948 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
8949 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
8950 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
8951 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008952
8953 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
8954 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
8955 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
8956 returned an HTTP 403 error.
8957
8958 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
8959 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
8960 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
8961 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
8962
8963 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
8964 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
8965 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
8966 only be solved by proper system tuning.
8967
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02008968The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
8969persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
8970important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
8971re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
8972
8973 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
8974
8975 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
8976 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
8977 set on a GET request.
8978
8979 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
8980 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
8981 a "server" entry is removed from the configuraton, since its cookie
8982 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
8983
8984 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
8985 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
8986 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
8987
8988 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
8989 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
8990 already got a cookie.
8991
8992 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
8993 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
8994 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
8995 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
8996 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
8997
8998 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
8999 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
9000 new cookie was inserted in the response.
9001
9002 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
9003 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
9004 new cookie was inserted in the response.
9005
9006 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
9007 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
9008
9009 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
9010 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
9011 then advertised in the response.
9012
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009013
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020090148.6. Non-printable characters
9015-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009016
9017In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
9018consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
9019converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
9020prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
9021being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
9022escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
9023is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
9024'}' when logging headers.
9025
9026Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
9027issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
9028containing spaces is "User-Agent".
9029
9030Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
9031the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
9032performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
9033
9034
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020090358.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
9036---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009037
9038Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
9039achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009040section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009041cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
9042the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
9043the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009044locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009045not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
9046user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
9047a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
9048wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
9049
9050 Examples :
9051 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
9052 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
9053
9054 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
9055 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
9056
9057
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020090588.8. Capturing HTTP headers
9059---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009060
9061Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
9062proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
9063the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
9064server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
9065
9066Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
9067response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009068section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009069
9070It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009071time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
9072appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009073are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
9074and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
9075follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
9076request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
9077in the logs.
9078
9079 Example :
9080 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
9081 listen proxy-out
9082 mode http
9083 option httplog
9084 option logasap
9085 log global
9086 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
9087
9088 # log the name of the virtual server
9089 capture request header Host len 20
9090
9091 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
9092 capture request header Content-Length len 10
9093
9094 # log the beginning of the referrer
9095 capture request header Referer len 20
9096
9097 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
9098 capture response header Server len 20
9099
9100 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
9101 capture response header Content-Length len 10
9102
9103 # log the expected cache behaviour on the response
9104 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
9105
9106 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
9107 capture response header Via len 20
9108
9109 # log the URL location during a redirection
9110 capture response header Location len 20
9111
9112 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
9113 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
9114 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
9115 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
9116 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
9117
9118 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
9119 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
9120 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
9121 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009122 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009123
9124 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
9125 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
9126 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
9127 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
9128 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009129 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009130
9131
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020091328.9. Examples of logs
9133---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009134
9135These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
9136them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
9137reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
9138
9139 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
9140 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
9141 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
9142
9143 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
9144 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
9145
9146 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
9147 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
9148 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
9149
9150 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
9151 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
9152
9153 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
9154 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
9155 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
9156
9157 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009158 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009159 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
9160 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
9161
9162 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
9163 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
9164 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
9165
9166 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
9167 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
9168 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensible information which
9169 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
9170 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
9171 to return the 502 and not the server.
9172
9173 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009174 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009175
9176 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
9177 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
9178 Nothing was sent to any server.
9179
9180 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
9181 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
9182
9183 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
9184 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
9185 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
9186 send a 408 return code to the client.
9187
9188 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
9189 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
9190
9191 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
9192 5 seconds ("c----").
9193
9194 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
9195 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009196 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009197
9198 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009199 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009200 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
9201 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
9202 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
9203 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
9204 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009205
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +01009206
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020092079. Statistics and monitoring
9208----------------------------
9209
9210It is possible to query HAProxy about its status. The most commonly used
9211mechanism is the HTTP statistics page. This page also exposes an alternative
9212CSV output format for monitoring tools. The same format is provided on the
9213Unix socket.
9214
9215
92169.1. CSV format
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +01009217---------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01009218
Willy Tarreau7f062c42009-03-05 18:43:00 +01009219The statistics may be consulted either from the unix socket or from the HTTP
9220page. Both means provide a CSV format whose fields follow.
9221
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01009222 0. pxname: proxy name
9223 1. svname: service name (FRONTEND for frontend, BACKEND for backend, any name
9224 for server)
9225 2. qcur: current queued requests
9226 3. qmax: max queued requests
9227 4. scur: current sessions
9228 5. smax: max sessions
9229 6. slim: sessions limit
9230 7. stot: total sessions
9231 8. bin: bytes in
9232 9. bout: bytes out
9233 10. dreq: denied requests
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +01009234 11. dresp: denied responses
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01009235 12. ereq: request errors
9236 13. econ: connection errors
Willy Tarreauae526782010-03-04 20:34:23 +01009237 14. eresp: response errors (among which srv_abrt)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01009238 15. wretr: retries (warning)
9239 16. wredis: redispatches (warning)
Cyril Bonté0dae5852010-02-03 00:26:28 +01009240 17. status: status (UP/DOWN/NOLB/MAINT/MAINT(via)...)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01009241 18. weight: server weight (server), total weight (backend)
9242 19. act: server is active (server), number of active servers (backend)
9243 20. bck: server is backup (server), number of backup servers (backend)
9244 21. chkfail: number of failed checks
9245 22. chkdown: number of UP->DOWN transitions
9246 23. lastchg: last status change (in seconds)
9247 24. downtime: total downtime (in seconds)
9248 25. qlimit: queue limit
9249 26. pid: process id (0 for first instance, 1 for second, ...)
9250 27. iid: unique proxy id
9251 28. sid: service id (unique inside a proxy)
9252 29. throttle: warm up status
9253 30. lbtot: total number of times a server was selected
9254 31. tracked: id of proxy/server if tracking is enabled
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02009255 32. type (0=frontend, 1=backend, 2=server, 3=socket)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkidb57c6b2009-08-31 21:23:27 +02009256 33. rate: number of sessions per second over last elapsed second
9257 34. rate_lim: limit on new sessions per second
9258 35. rate_max: max number of new sessions per second
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki09605412009-09-23 22:09:24 +02009259 36. check_status: status of last health check, one of:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01009260 UNK -> unknown
9261 INI -> initializing
9262 SOCKERR -> socket error
9263 L4OK -> check passed on layer 4, no upper layers testing enabled
9264 L4TMOUT -> layer 1-4 timeout
9265 L4CON -> layer 1-4 connection problem, for example
9266 "Connection refused" (tcp rst) or "No route to host" (icmp)
9267 L6OK -> check passed on layer 6
9268 L6TOUT -> layer 6 (SSL) timeout
9269 L6RSP -> layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
9270 L7OK -> check passed on layer 7
9271 L7OKC -> check conditionally passed on layer 7, for example 404 with
9272 disable-on-404
9273 L7TOUT -> layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
9274 L7RSP -> layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
9275 L7STS -> layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki09605412009-09-23 22:09:24 +02009276 37. check_code: layer5-7 code, if available
9277 38. check_duration: time in ms took to finish last health check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009278 39. hrsp_1xx: http responses with 1xx code
9279 40. hrsp_2xx: http responses with 2xx code
9280 41. hrsp_3xx: http responses with 3xx code
9281 42. hrsp_4xx: http responses with 4xx code
9282 43. hrsp_5xx: http responses with 5xx code
9283 44. hrsp_other: http responses with other codes (protocol error)
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009284 45. hanafail: failed health checks details
9285 46. req_rate: HTTP requests per second over last elapsed second
9286 47. req_rate_max: max number of HTTP requests per second observed
9287 48. req_tot: total number of HTTP requests received
Willy Tarreauae526782010-03-04 20:34:23 +01009288 49. cli_abrt: number of data transfers aborted by the client
9289 50. srv_abrt: number of data transfers aborted by the server (inc. in eresp)
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009290
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +01009291
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020092929.2. Unix Socket commands
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +01009293-------------------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +01009294
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +01009295The following commands are supported on the UNIX stats socket ; all of them
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +02009296must be terminated by a line feed. The socket supports pipelining, so that it
9297is possible to chain multiple commands at once provided they are delimited by
9298a semi-colon or a line feed, although the former is more reliable as it has no
9299risk of being truncated over the network. The responses themselves will each be
9300followed by an empty line, so it will be easy for an external script to match a
9301given response with a given request. By default one command line is processed
9302then the connection closes, but there is an interactive allowing multiple lines
9303to be issued one at a time.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +01009304
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +02009305It is important to understand that when multiple haproxy processes are started
9306on the same sockets, any process may pick up the request and will output its
9307own stats.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +01009308
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009309clear counters
9310 Clear the max values of the statistics counters in each proxy (frontend &
9311 backend) and in each server. The cumulated counters are not affected. This
9312 can be used to get clean counters after an incident, without having to
9313 restart nor to clear traffic counters. This command is restricted and can
9314 only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
9315
9316clear counters all
9317 Clear all statistics counters in each proxy (frontend & backend) and in each
9318 server. This has the same effect as restarting. This command is restricted
9319 and can only be issued on sockets configured for level "admin".
9320
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +09009321clear table <table> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
9322 Remove entries from the stick-table <table>.
9323
9324 This is typically used to unblock some users complaining they have been
9325 abusively denied access to a service, but this can also be used to clear some
9326 stickiness entries matching a server that is going to be replaced (see "show
9327 table" below for details). Note that sometimes, removal of an entry will be
9328 refused because it is currently tracked by a session. Retrying a few seconds
9329 later after the session ends is usual enough.
9330
9331 In the case where no options arguments are given all entries will be removed.
9332
9333 When the "data." form is used entries matching a filter applied using the
9334 stored data (see "stick-table" in section 4.2) are removed. A stored data
9335 type must be specified in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the
9336 table otherwise an error is reported. The data is compared according to
9337 <operator> with the 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with
9338 the ACLs :
9339
9340 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
9341 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
9342 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
9343 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
9344 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
9345 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
9346
9347 When the key form is used the entry <key> is removed. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +09009348 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer and
9349 string.
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02009350
9351 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02009352 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009353 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02009354 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
9355 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
9356 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
9357 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02009358
9359 $ echo "clear table http_proxy key 127.0.0.1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
9360
9361 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009362 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02009363 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
9364 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +09009365 $ echo "clear table http_proxy data.gpc0 eq 1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
9366 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
9367 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02009368
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009369disable server <backend>/<server>
9370 Mark the server DOWN for maintenance. In this mode, no more checks will be
9371 performed on the server until it leaves maintenance.
9372 If the server is tracked by other servers, those servers will be set to DOWN
9373 during the maintenance.
9374
9375 In the statistics page, a server DOWN for maintenance will appear with a
9376 "MAINT" status, its tracking servers with the "MAINT(via)" one.
9377
9378 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
9379 their numeric ID, prefixed with a dash ('#').
9380
9381 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
9382 level "admin".
9383
9384enable server <backend>/<server>
9385 If the server was previously marked as DOWN for maintenance, this marks the
9386 server UP and checks are re-enabled.
9387
9388 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
9389 their numeric ID, prefixed with a dash ('#').
9390
9391 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
9392 level "admin".
9393
9394get weight <backend>/<server>
9395 Report the current weight and the initial weight of server <server> in
9396 backend <backend> or an error if either doesn't exist. The initial weight is
9397 the one that appears in the configuration file. Both are normally equal
9398 unless the current weight has been changed. Both the backend and the server
9399 may be specified either by their name or by their numeric ID, prefixed with a
9400 dash ('#').
9401
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +02009402help
9403 Print the list of known keywords and their basic usage. The same help screen
9404 is also displayed for unknown commands.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +01009405
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +02009406prompt
9407 Toggle the prompt at the beginning of the line and enter or leave interactive
9408 mode. In interactive mode, the connection is not closed after a command
9409 completes. Instead, the prompt will appear again, indicating the user that
9410 the interpreter is waiting for a new command. The prompt consists in a right
9411 angle bracket followed by a space "> ". This mode is particularly convenient
9412 when one wants to periodically check information such as stats or errors.
9413 It is also a good idea to enter interactive mode before issuing a "help"
9414 command.
9415
9416quit
9417 Close the connection when in interactive mode.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +01009418
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009419set timeout cli <delay>
9420 Change the CLI interface timeout for current connection. This can be useful
9421 during long debugging sessions where the user needs to constantly inspect
9422 some indicators without being disconnected. The delay is passed in seconds.
9423
9424set weight <backend>/<server> <weight>[%]
9425 Change a server's weight to the value passed in argument. If the value ends
9426 with the '%' sign, then the new weight will be relative to the initially
9427 configured weight. Relative weights are only permitted between 0 and 100%,
9428 and absolute weights are permitted between 0 and 256. Servers which are part
9429 of a farm running a static load-balancing algorithm have stricter limitations
9430 because the weight cannot change once set. Thus for these servers, the only
9431 accepted values are 0 and 100% (or 0 and the initial weight). Changes take
9432 effect immediately, though certain LB algorithms require a certain amount of
9433 requests to consider changes. A typical usage of this command is to disable
9434 a server during an update by setting its weight to zero, then to enable it
9435 again after the update by setting it back to 100%. This command is restricted
9436 and can only be issued on sockets configured for level "admin". Both the
9437 backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by their
9438 numeric ID, prefixed with a dash ('#').
9439
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +01009440show errors [<iid>]
9441 Dump last known request and response errors collected by frontends and
9442 backends. If <iid> is specified, the limit the dump to errors concerning
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02009443 either frontend or backend whose ID is <iid>. This command is restricted
9444 and can only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or
9445 "admin".
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +01009446
9447 The errors which may be collected are the last request and response errors
9448 caused by protocol violations, often due to invalid characters in header
9449 names. The report precisely indicates what exact character violated the
9450 protocol. Other important information such as the exact date the error was
9451 detected, frontend and backend names, the server name (when known), the
9452 internal session ID and the source address which has initiated the session
9453 are reported too.
9454
9455 All characters are returned, and non-printable characters are encoded. The
9456 most common ones (\t = 9, \n = 10, \r = 13 and \e = 27) are encoded as one
9457 letter following a backslash. The backslash itself is encoded as '\\' to
9458 avoid confusion. Other non-printable characters are encoded '\xNN' where
9459 NN is the two-digits hexadecimal representation of the character's ASCII
9460 code.
9461
9462 Lines are prefixed with the position of their first character, starting at 0
9463 for the beginning of the buffer. At most one input line is printed per line,
9464 and large lines will be broken into multiple consecutive output lines so that
9465 the output never goes beyond 79 characters wide. It is easy to detect if a
9466 line was broken, because it will not end with '\n' and the next line's offset
9467 will be followed by a '+' sign, indicating it is a continuation of previous
9468 line.
9469
9470 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02009471 $ echo "show errors" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
9472 >>> [04/Mar/2009:15:46:56.081] backend http-in (#2) : invalid response
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +01009473 src 127.0.0.1, session #54, frontend fe-eth0 (#1), server s2 (#1)
9474 response length 213 bytes, error at position 23:
9475
9476 00000 HTTP/1.0 200 OK\r\n
9477 00017 header/bizarre:blah\r\n
9478 00038 Location: blah\r\n
9479 00054 Long-line: this is a very long line which should b
9480 00104+ e broken into multiple lines on the output buffer,
9481 00154+ otherwise it would be too large to print in a ter
9482 00204+ minal\r\n
9483 00211 \r\n
9484
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009485 In the example above, we see that the backend "http-in" which has internal
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +01009486 ID 2 has blocked an invalid response from its server s2 which has internal
9487 ID 1. The request was on session 54 initiated by source 127.0.0.1 and
9488 received by frontend fe-eth0 whose ID is 1. The total response length was
9489 213 bytes when the error was detected, and the error was at byte 23. This
9490 is the slash ('/') in header name "header/bizarre", which is not a valid
9491 HTTP character for a header name.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +01009492
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +02009493show info
9494 Dump info about haproxy status on current process.
9495
9496show sess
9497 Dump all known sessions. Avoid doing this on slow connections as this can
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02009498 be huge. This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets
9499 configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
9500
Willy Tarreau66dc20a2010-03-05 17:53:32 +01009501show sess <id>
9502 Display a lot of internal information about the specified session identifier.
9503 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
9504 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). Those information are
9505 useless to most users but may be used by haproxy developers to troubleshoot a
9506 complex bug. The output format is intentionally not documented so that it can
9507 freely evolve depending on demands.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +02009508
9509show stat [<iid> <type> <sid>]
9510 Dump statistics in the CSV format. By passing <id>, <type> and <sid>, it is
9511 possible to dump only selected items :
9512 - <iid> is a proxy ID, -1 to dump everything
9513 - <type> selects the type of dumpable objects : 1 for frontends, 2 for
9514 backends, 4 for servers, -1 for everything. These values can be ORed,
9515 for example:
9516 1 + 2 = 3 -> frontend + backend.
9517 1 + 2 + 4 = 7 -> frontend + backend + server.
9518 - <sid> is a server ID, -1 to dump everything from the selected proxy.
9519
9520 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02009521 $ echo "show info;show stat" | socat stdio unix-connect:/tmp/sock1
9522 >>> Name: HAProxy
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +02009523 Version: 1.4-dev2-49
9524 Release_date: 2009/09/23
9525 Nbproc: 1
9526 Process_num: 1
9527 (...)
9528
9529 # pxname,svname,qcur,qmax,scur,smax,slim,stot,bin,bout,dreq, (...)
9530 stats,FRONTEND,,,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,0,,,,,OPEN,,,,,,,,,1,1,0, (...)
9531 stats,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,0,0,0,,0,250,(...)
9532 (...)
9533 www1,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,1,1,0,,0,250, (...)
9534
9535 $
9536
9537 Here, two commands have been issued at once. That way it's easy to find
9538 which process the stats apply to in multi-process mode. Notice the empty
9539 line after the information output which marks the end of the first block.
9540 A similar empty line appears at the end of the second block (stats) so that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009541 the reader knows the output has not been truncated.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +02009542
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02009543show table
9544 Dump general information on all known stick-tables. Their name is returned
9545 (the name of the proxy which holds them), their type (currently zero, always
9546 IP), their size in maximum possible number of entries, and the number of
9547 entries currently in use.
9548
9549 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02009550 $ echo "show table" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
9551 >>> # table: front_pub, type: 0, size:204800, used:171454
9552 >>> # table: back_rdp, type: 0, size:204800, used:0
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02009553
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +09009554show table <name> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02009555 Dump contents of stick-table <name>. In this mode, a first line of generic
9556 information about the table is reported as with "show table", then all
9557 entries are dumped. Since this can be quite heavy, it is possible to specify
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +09009558 a filter in order to specify what entries to display.
9559
9560 When the "data." form is used the filter applies to the stored data (see
9561 "stick-table" in section 4.2). A stored data type must be specified
9562 in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the table otherwise an
9563 error is reported. The data is compared according to <operator> with the
9564 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with the ACLs :
9565
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02009566 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
9567 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
9568 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
9569 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
9570 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
9571 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
9572
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +09009573
9574 When the key form is used the entry <key> is shown. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +09009575 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer,
9576 and string.
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +09009577
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02009578 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02009579 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
9580 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: 0, size:204800, used:2
9581 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
9582 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
9583 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
9584 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02009585
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02009586 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
9587 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: 0, size:204800, used:2
9588 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
9589 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02009590
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02009591 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.conn_rate gt 5" | \
9592 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
9593 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: 0, size:204800, used:2
9594 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
9595 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02009596
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +09009597 $ echo "show table http_proxy key 127.0.0.2" | \
9598 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
9599 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: 0, size:204800, used:2
9600 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
9601 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
9602
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02009603 When the data criterion applies to a dynamic value dependent on time such as
9604 a bytes rate, the value is dynamically computed during the evaluation of the
9605 entry in order to decide whether it has to be dumped or not. This means that
9606 such a filter could match for some time then not match anymore because as
9607 time goes, the average event rate drops.
9608
9609 It is possible to use this to extract lists of IP addresses abusing the
9610 service, in order to monitor them or even blacklist them in a firewall.
9611 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02009612 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" \
9613 | socat stdio /tmp/sock1 \
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02009614 | fgrep 'key=' | cut -d' ' -f2 | cut -d= -f2 > abusers-ip.txt
9615 ( or | awk '/key/{ print a[split($2,a,"=")]; }' )
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki719e7262009-10-04 15:02:46 +02009616
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009617/*
9618 * Local variables:
9619 * fill-column: 79
9620 * End:
9621 */